Location via proxy:   [ UP ]  
[Report a bug]   [Manage cookies]                

Acc 419 PDF

Download as pdf or txt
Download as pdf or txt
You are on page 1of 228

NATIONAL OPEN UNIVERSITY OF NIGERIA

SCHOOL OF MANAGEMENT SCIENCES

COURSE CODE: ACC 419

COURESE TITLE: FINANCIAL ACCOUNTING


COURSE DEVELOPMENT ON

B. Sc. ACCOUNTING

ACC 419

FINANCIAL ACCOUNTING

COURSE GUIDE

Course Developer: ICAN STUDY PACK

Adapted by: Mrs. Ofe I. Inua

School of Management Sciences,

National Open University of Nigeria,

Lagos

Course Editor: Dr. I. D. Idrisu

School of Management Sciences,

National Open University of Nigeria,

2
Lagos

Programme Leader: Dr. Ibrahim D. Idrisu

School of Management Sciences,

National Open University of Nigeria,

Victoria Island, Lagos.

Course Coordinator: Mr. Emmanuel U. Abianga

School of Management Sciences,

National Open University of Nigeria,

Victoria Island, Lagos.

3
TABLE OF CONTENTS Page

Introduction

Course Aim

Course Objectives

Working through this course

Course Materials

Study Units

Textbooks and Reference

Assessment

Tutor Marked Assignment

Final Examination and Grading

Course Score Distribution

Course Overview / Presentation

How to get the most from this course

Tutors and Tutorials

Summary

4
ACC 419 FINANCIAL ACCOUNTING

1.0 INTRODUCTION

ACC 419 is a 400 level first semester course. It introduces you to accounting and reporting concepts,
analysis and interpretation as well as guide to presentation of financial statements of different
organisations.

2.0 WHAT YOU WILL LEARN IN THIS COURSE

This course guide tells you briefly what to expect from reading this course. The study of financial
accounting is to familiarize you with this subject matter which is dealt with herein and of which are
expected to know much about after reading through

3.0 COURSE AIMS

The aim of the course is to help the learner become reasonably well-informed about financial
accounting. It will also enable you to have the knowledge and skill of analysing, presenting and
reporting financial statements in different organisations.

4.0 COURSE OBJECTIVES

The major objectives of this course, as designed, are to enable the students to know all the relevant
enactments and legislations in relation to financial accounting in Nigeria and all over the world. As
well, students should be able to:

 Discuss the role of International Accounting Standards Board in providing the framework for the
preparation of financial statements;
 State the objectives and elements of financial statements;
 Trace the history of Companies and Allied Matters Act (CAMA, 2004);
 Explain the purpose and objectives of cash flow statement, goodwill and disclosures required in
financial statements;
 Enumerate the parties that are always interested in the interpretation of financial statements;
 Distinguish between Construction contract, Long term contract, Short term contract, Building
contract and Civil contract;
 State two functions of a Stockbroker;
 Distinguish between investment purchased or sold Cum– Div and Ex – Div;

5
 Define the concepts investment and investment account;
 Prepare the accounts of specialised companies such as shipping as well as cooperative
societies;
 Define cooperative society and enumerate the guiding principles of the society;
 Differentiate between the roles and objectives of International Accounting Standard Board, the
Nigeria Accounting Standards Board;
 List and explain the generally accepted accounting principles (GAAP) governing analysis and
presentation of financial statements;
 Explain the nature of investment accounting and accounting for lease and hire purchase;
 State the legal and regulatory framework of group accounts, application of such framework to
preparation of consolidated profit and loss account and balance sheet.

5.0 WORKING THROUGH THIS COURSE

For you to excel in this course, you are required to carefully read each unit, and understand the
contents. You are also required to attempt each unit self-assessment exercises and submit your
assignment for assessment purposes. Apart from studying the course material on your own, you
also need to attend tutorial sessions for exchange of ideas with your Facilitator.

You are expected to compile the questions that bug you and the grey areas in the course materials
and bring these for discussion with fellow learners and the Facilitator. You are expected to carve out
specific time each day, every day for your study. Try to form good study habits. Remember that you
are a self-learner. In other words, you are on your own. If you study hard everyday and do your
assignments, you will achieve your goal.

6.0 COURSE MATERIALS

You will be provided with the following materials:

 Course Guide
 Course Material containing Study Units
 Assignment file

7.0 STUDY UNITS

The study units in this course are as follows:

MODULE 1

6
Unit 1: Accounting and Reporting Concepts

Unit 2: Company Accounts and Reports

Unit 3: Preparation of a Published Financial Statement

Unit 4: Preparation of Cash Flow Statement

Unit 5: Analysis and Preparation of Financial Statements

Unit 6: Contract Accounts

MODULE TWO

Unit 1: Investment Accounting

Unit 2: Accounting for Lease and Hire Purchase

Unit 3: Accounting for Specialised Businesses

Unit 4: Generally Accepted Accounting Principles (GAAP)

Unit 5: Development, Contents and Application of Accounting


Unit 6: Regulatory Framework of Financial Accounting

MODULE THREE

Unit 1: Legal and Regulatory Framework of Group Accounts


Unit 2: Consolidated Balance Sheet
Unit 3: Consolidated Profit and Loss Account
Unit 4: Associated Companies

Unit 5: Disposal of Subsidiaries

Unit 6: Group Cash Flow

All these units are demanding. They also deal with basic principles and values, which merit your
attention and thought. Tackle them in separate study periods. You may require several hours for
each.

We suggest that the Modules be studied one after the other, since they are linked by a common
theme. You will gain more from them if you have first carried out work on the scope of Family Law
generally. You will then have a clearer picture into which to paint these topics. Subsequent courses
are written on the assumption that you have completed these units.

7
Each study units consists of one week’s work and includes specific objectives, directions for study,
reading materials and self assessment exercises (SAEs). Together with tutor marked assignments
(TMAs), these exercises will assist you in achieving the stated learning objectives of the individual
units and of the course.

8.0 ASSESSMENTS

There are two types of assessment for this course: the Tutor Marked Assignment (TMA), the end of
course examination.

In tackling the assignments, you are expected to apply information, knowledge and techniques
gathered during the course. The assignments must be submitted to your tutor for formal
assessment in accordance with the deadlines stated in the Presentation Schedule and the
Assignment File. The work you submitted to your tutor will count for 30% of your total course mark.

At the end of the course, you will need to sit for a final written examination of ‘three hours’
duration. This examination will also count for 50% of your total course mark.

9.0 TUTOR-MARKED ASSIGNMENT (TMAs)

The re is a Tutor Marked Assignment (TMA) at the end for every unit. You are required to attempt
all the assignments. You will be assessed on all of them but the best three performances will be
used for assessment. The assignment carry 10% each.

When you have completed each assignment, send it together with a (Tutor Marked Assignment)
form, to your tutor. Make sure that teach assignment reaches your tutor on or before the deadline.
If for any reason you cannot complete your work on time, contact your tutor before the assignment
is due to discuss the possibility of an extension. Extensions will not be granted after the due date
unless under exceptional circumstances.

10.0 FINAL EXAMINATION AND GRADING

The end of course examination carries 70% of the total score for the course. You will be notified of
the time of the examination. You should prepare thoroughly for the examination by studying very
hard. You should also submit yourself for the examination.
8
11.0 COURSE SCORE DISTRIBUTION

The following table lays out how the actual course marking is broken down:

ASSESSMENT MARKS

Assignment 1 – 4 (TMAs) (the best three of all Four assignments. Best three marks of the
the assignments submitted) four count at 30% of course marks

Final Examination 70% of overall course marks

Total 100% of course marks

12.0 COURSE OVERVIEW

This table brings together the units and the number of weeks you should take to complete them and
the assignment that follow them.

Unit Title of work Weeks activity Assessment (end of


unit)

Module 1

1 Accounting and Reporting Concepts 1 1

2 Company Accounts and Reports 1

3 Preparation of a Published Financial Statement 1 2

4 Preparation of Cash Flow Statement 1

5 Analysis and Preparation of Financial Statements 1 3

6 Contract Accounts 1

Module 2

1 Investment Accounting 1 4

2 Accounting for Lease and Hire Purchase 1

3 Accounting for Specialised Businesses 1

9
4 Generally Accepted Accounting Principles (GAAP) 1 5

5 Development, Contents and Application of 1


Accounting

6 Regulatory Framework of Financial Accounting 1 6

Module 3

1 Legal and Regulatory Framework of Group 1 7


Accounts

2 Consolidated Balance Sheet 1

3 Consolidated Profit and Loss Account 1

4 Associated Companies 1 8

5 Disposal of Subsidiaries 1

6 Group Cash Flow 1 9

Revision 2

Total 20

13.0 HOW TO GET THE MOST FROM THIS COURSE

In distance learning, the study units are specially developed and designed to replace the university
lecturer. Hence, you can work through these materials at your own pace, and at a time and place
that suits you best. Visualize it as reading the lecture instead listening to a lecturer.

Each of the study units follows a common format. The first item is an introduction to the subject
matter of the unit, and how a particular unit is integrated with the other units and the course as a
whole. Next is a set of learning objectives. These objectives let you know what you should be able
to do by the time you have completed the unit. You should use these objectives to guide your study.
When you have finished the unit, you must go back and check whether you have achieved the
objectives. If you make a habit of doing this, you will significantly improve your chances of passing
the course.

The main body of the unit guides you through the required reading from other sources. This will
usually be either from your set books or from a Reading Section. You will be directed when you need
to use a computer and guided through the tasks you must do. The purpose of the computing work is
10
two-fold. First, it will enhance your understanding of the material in the unit. Second, it will give
you practical experiences of using programmes which you could well encounter in your work outside
your studies. In any event, most of the techniques you will study are applicable on computers in
normal working practice, so it is important you encounter them during your studies.

Activities are interspersed throughout the units, and answers are given at the end of the units.
Working through these tests will help you to achieve the objectives of the units and prepare you for
the assignments and the examinations. You should do each activity as you come to it in the study
unit. There are also numerous examples given in the study units, work through these when you
come to them, too.

The following is a practical strategy for working through the course. If you run into any trouble,
telephone your facilitator or post the questions on the Web CT OLE’s discussion board. Remember
that your facilitator’s job is to help you. When you need help, don’t hesitate to call and ask your
tutor to provide it. In summary,

 Read this course guide.

 Organise a study schedule. Refer to the course overview for more details. Note the time you
are expected to spend on each unit and how the assignments relate to the unit. Important
information e.g. details of your tutorials, and the date of the first day of the semester is available
from the portal. You need to gather together all this information in one place, such as your diary
or a wall calendar. Whatever method you choose to use, you should decide on and write in your
own dates for working on each unit.

 Once you have created your own study schedule, do everything you can to stick to it. The major
reason that students fail is that they get behind with their coursework. If you get into difficulties
with your schedule, please let your facilitator know before it is too late for help.

 Turn to unit 1 and read the introduction and the objectives for the unit.

 Assemble the study materials. Information about what you need for a unit is given in the
‘Overview’ at the beginning of each unit. You will always need both the study unit you are
working on and one of your set books, on your desk at the same time.

 Work through the unit. The content of the unit itself has been arranged to provide a sequence
for you to follow. As you work through this unit, you will be instructed to read sections from
your set books or other articles. Use the unit to guide your reading.

 Up-to-date course information will be continuously posted to your portal.


11
 Well before the relevant due dates (about 4 weeks before the dates) access the Assignment file
on the portal and download your next required assignment. Keep in mind that you will learn a
lot by doing the assignments carefully. They have been designed to help you meet the
objectives of the course and, therefore, will help you pass the examination. Submit all
assignments not later than the due dates.

 Review the objectives for each study unit confirm that you have achieved them. If you feel
unsure about any of the objectives, review the study material or consult your tutor.
 When you are confident that you have achieved a unit’s objectives, you can then start on the
next unit. Proceed unit by unit through the course and try to pace your study so that you keep
yourself on schedule.

 When you have submitted an assignment to your tutor for marking, do not wait for its return
before starting on the next unit. Keep to your schedule. When the assignment is returned, pay
particular attention to your facilitator’s comments. Consult your tutor as soon as possible if you
have any questions or problems.

 After completing the last unit, review the course and prepare yourself for the final examination.
Check that you have achieved the unit objectives and the course objectives.

14.0 TUTORS AND TUTORIALS

There are 18 hours of tutorials (ten 2-hour sessions) provided in support of this course. You will be
notified of the dates, times and location of these tutorials, together with the names and phone
number of your tutor, as soon as you are allocated a tutorial group.

Your tutor will mark and comment on your assignments, keep a close watch on your progress and on
any difficulties you might encounter as they would provide assistance to you during the course. You
must mail your tutor-marked assignments to your tutor well before the due date (at least two
working days are required). They will be marked by your tutor and returned to you as soon as
possible. Do not hesitate to contact your tutor by telephone, e-mail, or discussion board if you need
help. The following might be circumstances in which you would find help necessary: when

 you do not understand any part of the study units or the assigned readings.
 you have difficulty with the self-tests or exercises.
 you have a question or problem with an assignment with your tutor’s comment on an
assignment or with the grading of an assignment.

You should try your possible best to attend the tutorials. This is the only chance to have face-to-face
contact with your tutor and to ask questions which are answered instantly. You can raise any
12
problem encountered in the course of your study. To gain the maximum benefit from course
tutorials, prepare a question list before attending them. You will learn a lot from participations in
discussions.

15.0 SUMMARY

The course ACC 419 examines the contents of Financial Accounting. The course is designed and
developed for your benefit as an accounting student.

I hope that you will find this course interesting and exciting. The course is a living course. As you go
through it, you will develop more insight into family law and the family property.

We hope you enjoy your acquaintances with the National Open University of Nigeria (NOUN). We
wish you success in this course. Success in this course will help you attain your life goals. Best
wishes and regards.

13
COURSE DEVELOPMENT ON

B. Sc. ACCOUNTING

ACC 419

FINANCIAL ACCOUNTING

Course Developer: ICAN STUDY PACK

Adapted by: Mrs. Ofe I. Inua


School of Management Sciences,
National Open University of Nigeria,
Lagos

Course Editor: Dr. I. D. Idrisu


School of Management Sciences,
National Open University of Nigeria,
Lagos

Programme Leader: Dr. Ibrahim D. Idrisu


School of Management Sciences,
National Open University of Nigeria,
Victoria Island, Lagos.

Course Coordinator: Mr. Emmanuel U. Abianga


School of Management Sciences,
National Open University of Nigeria,
Victoria Island, Lagos.

14
MODULE ONE

Unit 1 Accounting and Reporting Concepts


Unit 2 Company Accounts and Reports
Unit 3 Preparation of Published Financial Statements
Unit 4 Preparation of a Cash Flow Statement
Unit 5 Analysis and Interpretation of Financial Statements
Unit 6 Contract Accounts

UNIT ONE ACCOUNTING AND REPORTING CONCEPTS

CONTENTS

1.0 Introduction
2.0 Objectives
3.0 Main Content
3.1 Financial Statements
3.2 The International Accounting Standards Board
3.3 Objectives of Financial Statements
3.4 Underlying Assumptions
3.5 Qualitative Characteristics of Financial Statements
3.6 Elements of Financial Statements
4.0 Conclusion
5.0 Summary
6.0 Tutor-Marked Assignment
7.0 References/Further Readings

1.0 INTRODUCTION

You are welcome to this course on financial accounting. In this module, you will be
introduced to six (6) units whose titles are: Accounting and Reporting Concepts; Company
Accounts and Reports; Preparation of Published Financial Statements; Preparation of a Cash
Flow Statement; Analysis and Interpretation of Financial Statements and Contract Accounts.

In this unit, you will be introduced to accounting and report concepts. The unit will take you
through the study of financial statements, IASB framework, objectives, underlying
assumptions, qualitative characteristics and the elements of financial statements.

2.0 OBJECTIVES

After studying this unit, readers should be able to:

 explain the objectives and qualitative characteristics of financial statements and


information;

 identify the differences in the financial statements prepared under the accrual basis, cash
basis and break-up basis;

 understand the measurement basis and recognition criteria of the elements of financial
statements.

15
3.0 MAIN CONTENT

3.1 Financial Statements

Financial statements possess certain qualitative characteristics that enhance the usefulness of
the information they convey to users. In this unit, we shall look at the elements and desirable
qualities of financial statements. A number of these issues are covered in the Framework for
the preparation and presentation of financial statements issued by the International
Accounting Standards Boards (IASB).

3.2 The International Accounting Standards Board (IASB) Framework

In July 1989, the International Accounting Standards Committee (IASC), now replaced by
the International Accounting Standards Board (IASB), produced a document titled, simply
“The Framework”. This document sets out the concepts that determine how financial
statements are prepared and the information they contain. This is why the IASB is also called
the “Conceptual Framework”.

A conceptual framework is a clearly defined set of objectives and principles that can lead to
the production of consistent accounting standards. The framework is therefore the
“conceptual framework”, the frame of reference from which the accounting standards issued
by the IASB are constructed.

3.2.1 Purpose of the Framework

The framework is expected to serve the following purposes:

(a) Assist in the development of future accounting standards and in the review of existing
standards.

(b) Assist in promoting harmonization of regulations, accounting standards and


procedures, relating to the presentation of financial statements by providing a basis
for reducing the number of alternative accounting treatments permitted by
International accounting standards.

(c) Assist national standard-setting bodies in developing national standards.

(d) Assist preparers of financial statements in applying international accounting standards


and in dealing with issues not yet covered by an International Accounting Standards
(IAS).

(e) Assist auditors in forming an opinion as to whether financial statements conform to


IASs.

(f) Assist users of financial statements in interpreting the information contained in


financial statements that comply with IASs; and

(g) Provide those who are interested in the work of the IASB with information on its
approach to the formulation of accounting standards.

16
3.2.2 Status of the Framework

In the event of a conflict between the Framework and an International Financial Reporting
Standard (IFRS), the latter will prevail.

3.2.3 Scope of the Framework

The framework deals with the following:

(a) The objectives of financial statements.


(b) Underlying assumptions.
(c) Qualitative characteristics of financial statements.
(d) Definition, recognition and measurement of the elements of financial statements; and
(e) Concepts of capital and capital maintenance.

3.3 Objectives of Financial Statements

The objectives of financial statements are to provide information about the financial position,
performance and changes in financial position that will assist a wide spectrum of users in
making useful economic decisions. The Framework identifies the following users of financial
information: investors, employees, lenders, suppliers, customers, government and the public.
Information on the financial performance of an entity is basically provided by the income
statement. Such information is useful in evaluating the returns obtained by an entity from the
resources available to it.

Information about changes in financial position is contained in the cash flow statement and is
useful in assessing an entity’s ability to generate cash and how the cash generated is utilised.

3.4 Underlying Assumptions

The framework specifies and explains two main assumptions that underlie the preparation of
financial statements. These assumptions are:

3.4.1 Accrual Basis

W hen financial statements are prepared under the accrual basis of accounting, the effects of
transactions and other events are recognized when they occur and not as cash or its equivalent
are received or paid. They are recorded in the accounting records and reported in the financial
statements, of the periods to which they relate.

3.4.2 Going Concern Basis

Under the going concern basis, the enterprise is regarded as a going concern, that is, as
continuing in operation for the foreseeable future. It is assumed that the enterprise has neither
the intention nor the necessity to liquidate or reduce materially the scale of its operations.

Illustration 1-1

Exotic Furniture Nig. Ltd recorded the following transactions in the first week of January
20x9:

17
(a) Rented an office space in Port Harcourt for N 1 million per annum and paid N 5 million,
being rent for five years demanded by the landlord.

(b) Bought office equipment for N 240,000 on credit from Modern Business Machines Ltd.
The expected useful life of the equipment is four years.

(c) Received cheque of N 1.3million from Rivers State Polytechnic, Bori, being final
payment for sales made to the institution in 20x7.

(d) Sold furniture items on credit to a local government in Rivers State for N 4 million. The
local government did not pay until the following year.

You are required to prepare extracts of the income statement and balance sheet of the
company for the year ended 31 December, 20x9, on the assumption that financial statements
are prepared under (a) the accrual basis and (b) the cash basis of accounting.

Suggested Solution 1-1

Exotic Furniture Nigeria Ltd


Income statement for the year ended 31 December 20x9 (extract)
Accrual basis cash basis
N’ 000 N’ 000
Sales 4000 1300
Rent 1000 5000
Depreciation (240,000 x 1/4) 60 -

Exotic Furniture Nigeria Ltd


Balance sheet as at 31 December 20x9 (extract)

Accrual Basis Cash


Basis
N’ 000 N’ 000
Property, plant and equipment 180 nil

Under the cash basis of accounting, as can be readily seen from the suggested solution to
illustration 1.1, the effects of transactions and other events are recognized when cash or its
equivalent is received or paid (and not when they occur), and they are recorded in the
accounting records and reported in financial statements of the periods in which cash or its
equivalent is received or paid.

Illustration 1-2

The values of the following non-current assets have been presented by the accountant of
Antsa Farms Ltd. The figures are in respect of the year ended 31 December 20x8

Net book value Market value


N’ N’
Land 24 42
Plant and machinery 8 5
18
Equipment 4 2
Motor vehicles 6 7

This would be the carrying values of the assets in the Balance Sheet of Antsa Farms Ltd, as at
31 December, 20x8, if:

(a) Antsa Farms Ltd is expected to continue its operation in the foreseeable future?

(b) Antsa Farms Ltd will be liquidated on 31 July 20x9? Assume that the liquidating values
of the company’s assets are equal to the market values given above.

Suggested Solution 1-2


Antsa Farms ltd
Carrying values of assets as at 31 December, 2008.
Where going concern Where going concern
principle is applicable principle is not applicable
N’ N’
Land 24 42
Plant and machinery 8 5
Equipment 4 2
Motor vehicles 6 7

Note that if the going concern assumption is no longer applicable, the assets of an enterprise
will be carried at their liquidating values.

3.5 Qualitative Characteristics of Financial Statements

This will be discussed under the following sub-topics.

3.5.1 Meaning of Qualitative characteristics

Qualitative characteristics are the attributes that make the information provided in financial
statements useful to users. The four principal qualitative characteristics are namely:
understandability, relevance, reliability and comparability.

3.5.2 True and fair view/ fair presentation

Financial statements are usually required to give a true and fair view, or present fairly the
financial position and performance of an entity.

3.6 Elements of the Financial Statements

The financial effects of transactions and events are grouped into broad classes namely assets,
liabilities, equity, income and expenses. The first three elements are shown in the Balance
Sheet and used in measuring the financial position of an entity, while the last two elements
(income and expenses) are used to measure the performance of an entity and are shown in the
income statement.

(a) An asset is a resource controlled by an entity as a result of past events and from which
future economic benefits are expected to flow to the entity.

19
(b) Liability – A liability is a present obligation of the entity arising from past events, the
settlement of which is expected to result in an outflow from the entity, of resources
embodying economic benefits.

(c) Equity is the residual interest in the assets of the entity after deducting all its liabilities.

(d) Income items have been defined by the framework as increases in economic benefits
during the accounting period, in the form of inflows or enhancements of assets or
decrease of liabilities that result in increases in equity, other than those relating to
contributions from equity participants.

(e) Expenses are decreases in economic benefits during an accounting period in the form of
outflows or depletions of assets or incurring of liabilities that result in decreases in equity,
other than those relating to distributions to equity participants.

Self Assessment Exercise 1.1

1. Explain what you understand by the term “conceptual framework”.

2. State two scopes of the IASB framework.

3. _______________ is the principle that discourages accountants from recognising the


profit of an enterprise if there’s no reasonable certainty that it is realisable.

4.0 CONCLUSION

The year 1989 marked a turning point in the conceptualisation of the framework on how
financial statements are prepared and the information they contain. The framework is
expected to assist in the development of future accounting standards and in reviewing the
existing standards; promoting harmonisation of regulations, accounting standards and
procedures; developing national standards; preparers of financial statements in applying
international standards and also dealing with issues not yet covered by the International
Accounting Standards (IASs); auditors informing an opinion as to whether financial
statements confirm to IASs; users of financial statements in interpreting the information
contained in financial statements that comply with IASs; and providing information on the
approach to the formulation of accounting standards.

5.0 SUMMARY

In this unit, we have examined the basic concepts that guide the production and presentation
of financial statements. These concepts include the objectives, elements, and attributes of
financial statements and the IASB conceptual framework.

In the next unit, you will be introduced to another interesting topic titled: company accounts
and reports.

6.0 TUTOR-MARKED ASSIGNMENT

The role of International Accounting Standards Board is that of providing a framework for
the preparation of financial statements. In the light of this statement, answer the following
questions:
20
(a) List the purposes of the framework for producing financial statements.
(b) Enumerate the scope of the framework.
(c) What are the objectives of financial statements?
(d) List and briefly explain the elements of financial statements.

7.0 REFERENCES/FURTHER READINGS

Adapted from the ICAN Study Packs (2011)

21
UNIT TWO COMPANY ACCOUNTS AND REPORT

CONTENTS

1.0 Introduction
2.0 Objectives
3.0 Main Content
3.1 Companies and Allied Matters Act (CAMA)
3.2 Statutory Framework
3.3 Users of Accounting Information
3.4 Contents of Financial Statements
4.0 Conclusion
5.0 Summary
6.0 Tutor-Marked Assignment
7.0 References/Further Readings

1.0 INTRODUCTION

In the last unit, we examined the basic concepts that guide the production and presentation of
financial statements. These concepts include the objectives, elements, and attributes of
financial statements and the IASB conceptual framework.

In this unit, you will learn about the Companies and Allied Matters Act, its provisions in
respect of the format for presentation and contents of financial statements. You will also be
introduced to the basic information needs of the various users of financial information.

2.0 OBJECTIVES

At the end of this unit, you should be able to:

 Enumerate the provisions of Companies and Allied Matters Act (CAMA), CAP C20 LFN
2004, in respect of the format and contents of financial statements.

 Discuss the basic information needs of the various users of financial information.

3.0 MAIN CONTENT

Iornongu (2009) traced the history of the development or evolution of company law in
Nigeria and stated it is a very interesting and compelling study. According to him, before the
advent of cross border trade in the territory now known as Nigeria, trading was done
predominantly by barter. However with the advent of the Arab traders in the north and
Portuguese and British traders in the South, trade began to expand astronomically. However,
there was no regulatory mechanism to guide business transactions in any form. There then
arose the need to protect the interests of the aliens whose method of trading was much more
advanced and sophisticated. As the political development of Nigeria was going with the
creation of colonies and protectorates so also ordinances were being introduced to regulate
and formalize the formation of companies.

The principle of corporate personality had established that once a company was incorporated
either by statute or through registration with the Corporate Affairs Commission (CAC)

22
pursuant to the provisions of the Companies and Allied Matters Act, it acquires a separate
and distinct legal personality.

3.1 Companies and Allied Matters Act (CAMA) 2004

This Act has made some revolutionary and landmark provisions not only for companies, but
also for the registration of business names and for the incorporation of trustees. This was
done in order to take care of emerging global trend in the conduct of business transactions.
The Act is divided into four parts, namely, Part A deals with registration of companies, Part
B deals with the registration of Business Names, Part C deals the registration of Incorporated
Trustees and Part D- Citation and commencement. With reference to companies, the declared
objective and the Nigerian Law Reform Commission was to evolve a comprehensive body of
legal principles and rules governing companies and suitable for the circumstances of the
country.

In pursuance of this objective, a broad approach was adopted. Not only the statutory
provisions but also the common law principles and the doctrines of equity applicable to
company law in Nigeria were examined and, wherever desirable, enacted, and often with
necessary amendments. As indicated above, the Act is a product of careful consideration and
extensive consultation. It represents the general views and consensus of users of company
law in Nigeria. The following major innovations of the Act may be noted.

(a) Comprehensiveness of the Act: first by the enactment of some relevant principles of
common law and doctrines of equity; and secondly, by incorporation in the
substantive enactment many of the common and general provisions of the articles in
Table A of the Companies Act. 1968;

(b) More logical arrangement of the subject matter of the Act.

(c) Establishment of a Corporate Affairs Commission to administer the Companies and


Allied Matter Act.

(d) Encouraging greater seriousness and commitment in the formation and registration of
companies by requiring a minimum authorized share capital and minimum
subscription.

(e) Prohibition of non-voting shares and of weighted votes.

(f) Abolition of the common law rules on pre-incorporation contracts and the provision
for ratification and adoption of such contracts.

(g) Provision for greater and more effective participation in and control of, the affairs of
the companies through improved provision in respect of meeting.

(h) Expanded provisions for relief against illegal and oppressive acts including provision
for derivative action relief against unfairly prejudicial conduct

(i) Provisions for greater accountability by directors.

(j) Provision for the appointment, qualification, duties and tenure of office of secretaries
of public companies.
23
(k) Improvement in the forms and contents of financial statement, classification of
companies into small, and others for the purpose of greater financial disclosure,
incorporation of Accounting Standards and provision for greater and more relevant
disclosure in the Directors’ Report.

(l) More comprehensive provisions in respect of receivership.

(m) Provisions for the incorporation, authorization and control of unit trust schemes.

(n) Provisions dealing with insider trading.

(o) Provisions regulating mergers and take-over subject to the Securities and Exchange
Commission Act.

Another innovation introduced by the Act is the Administration of the Act itself: The
administration of the Act is divided between the Corporate Affairs Commission which
administers the whole of the Act except part XVII. Part XVII which is administered by
Securities and Exchange Commission makes provisions in respect of Public Offer and sale of
securities, Unit Trusts, Reconstruction, Mergers and Take-overs of companies, and insider
trading.

Idigbe (2007) said that the CAMA 1990 as amended provides numerous provisions for
corporate accounting and auditing practices (auditing, disclosures, preparation and
publication of financial statements. The Registrar of Companies at the Corporate Affairs
Commission (CAC) is to monitor compliance with these requirements and specifies obsolete
penalties in case of non-compliance. Please see generally sections 137, 211 (3) & (5), 343,
345, 354 CAMA),

It further provides for appointment, remuneration, rights, functions, powers, and removal of
auditors and the establishment of an audit committee (please see generally sections 357, 358,
362,363 in part XI of CAMA). It should be noted that the CAMA regrettably does not
provide for joint audit or rotation of auditors. By virtue of S358 CAMA only chartered
accountants can be appointed as auditors of companies.

It also provide for the meetings of corporate entities. For companies, it is usually the Annual
General Meeting (Section 213 CAMA). All companies are also required to file Annual
returns which should contain their financial statement. It should be noted that CAMA allows
for the creation of different kinds of corporate entities (e.g. private limited liability company,
public limited liability company, company limited guarantee, unlimited company,
incorporated trustee and business name or firm), each with its attendant distinct legal
consequences associated with their incorporation and differential financial reporting
requirements (creating varying degree of elaborate corporate governance structure).

3.2 Statutory Framework of CAMA

Section 331 of Companies and Allied Matters Act (CAMA), Cap C20 LFN 2004, states the
procedures that apply to accounting records of a company.

Section 334 of CAM A further states that:

24
(a) In the case of every company, the directors shall in respect of each year of the
company, prepare financial statements for the year.

(b) The financial statements required shall include:

(i) statement of accounting policies;


(ii) the balance sheet as at the last day of the company’s financial year;
(iii) a profit and loss account or an income and expenditure account for the year;
(iv) notes to the accounts;
(v) the auditors’ report;
(vi) the directors’ report;
(vii) the Audit Committee’s report;
(viii) Cash flow statement;
(ix) a value-added statement for the year;
(x) a five-year financial summary; and
(xi) In the case of a holding company, the group financial statements.

The financial statements of a private company need not include the matters stated in
paragraphs (i), (vii), (viii), and (ix) in sub-section (b) above.

3.3 Users of Accounting Information

Accounting information is required by a wide range of users for various reasons. These users
include:

(a) Individuals, financial institutions or group of investors


(b) Managers in an enterprise
(c) Customers and employees of enterprises
(d) Government and regulatory bodies such as CBN, SEC, FIRS, NSE, SIRS etc
(e) Quasi government establishments
(f) Competitors
(g) Creditors
(h) Financial analysts

To meet the objectives of its diverse users, some of whom may not have accounting
knowledge or background; financial statements are expected to be simple, clear and easy to
understand.

3.4 Contents of Financial Statements

Financial Statements are expected to be drawn up in conformity with:

(a) GAAP means 'Generally Accepted Accounting Principles – The common set of
accounting principles, standards and procedures that companies use to compile their
financial statements. GAAP are a combination of authoritative standards (set by policy
boards) and simply the commonly accepted ways of recording and reporting accounting
information.

(b) SAS issued up to date by the NASB

(c) the books of accounts of the entity; and


25
(d) The Companies and Allied Matters Act, Cap. C 20 LFN 2004. Treatment of accounting
matters not at present covered by the Nigerian Accounting Standards is to conform to the
International Accounting Standards (IAS).

3.4.1 Statement of Accounting Policies

Accounting policies are those bases, rules, principles, conventions and procedures adopted in
preparing and presenting financial statements.

(a) Accounting convention: There should be information as to the fact that the financial
statements are prepared on the historical cost basis; that is, no adjustment for specific or
general price level changes such as inflation. Revaluation of some or all assets should be
so stated.

(b) Fixed assets: Directors may decide the minimum expenditure to be recognised as capital
item. It should also be stated that fixed assets are stated at cost or valuation, less
accumulated depreciation.

(c) Depreciation of fixed assets: The basis of depreciation of each class of fixed assets has to
be stated. The methods which can be used include Straight-Line, Reducing Balance,
amortisation over lives of the assets, Sum-of-the years digit. The rate of depreciation for
each class of fixed assets should be stated.

(d) Debtors are stated after the deduction of specific or general provision for any debts
considered doubtful of recovery.

(e) Stocks are stated at the lower of cost and net realisable value, after making provision for
obsolete and damaged items. For manufactured goods, ‘cost’ may include a proportion
of factory overhead.

(f) Investments are stated at cost. Diminution in value is not taken into account unless it is
considered to be permanent.

(g) Turnover represents the net invoiced value of sales to external customers.

(h) Deferred taxation is provided for by the liability method which represents taxation at the
current rate of company income tax, and the difference between the net book value of the
assets qualifying for capital allowances and their corresponding tax written down values.

(i) Foreign currencies transactions are translated to Naira at the rates of exchange ruling on
the dates of the transactions. Monetary assets and liabilities denominated in foreign
currencies are translated at the official rates ruling at the balance sheet date. Exchange
gains and losses are included in the profit and loss account of the period in which they
arise.

(j) Employees’ retirement benefit schemes: The company makes annual provision for
retirement benefits under its unfunded pension plan, using the aggregate method based
upon actual valuation. Under this method, costs related to the plan are charged over the
average service lives of active employees.

26
(k) Research and development: Expenditure on research is charged to the profit and loss
account in the year it is incurred, while development expenditure can be capitalised if it
meets certain criteria set out in IA S 38.

(l) Consolidation (For Group / Holding company): The group financial statements comprise
the financial statements of the company and its subsidiaries. All inter-company
transactions are normally eliminated.

3.4.2 Balance sheet

The balance sheet and related notes should disclose the following information:

(a) Fixed assets (property, plant and equipment): Land-freehold and leasehold, Buildings,
Plant and Equipment and other categories of assets, such as motor vehicles, fixtures and
fittings and Accumulated depreciation for each class of assets.

(b) Long–term investments (quoted and unquoted): investments in subsidiaries, investments


in associated companies and other investments.

(c) All long term debts including their tenure.

(d) Intangible assets: goodwill, patents and trademarks, deferred charges and any write-offs
during the period.

(e) Current assets: Stocks and Work-in-progress, current portion of long-term debts, trade
debts, prepayments and Sundry debtors, directors debit balances, inter-company debit
balances of subsidiaries and associated companies, short-term investments (including
Treasury Bills, certificates of deposit and commercial notes, bills of exchange), foreign
Currency Deposits for imports, deposits awaiting remittances to overseas creditors; and
cash and Bank balances

(f) Capital and reserves: The variety of ownership interests such as deferred shares, ordinary
shares, preference shares, cumulative and non-cumulative, participating and non-
participating preference shares.

(g) Other shareholder interests indicating movements during the period by way of bonus:
capital redemption reserve fund, share premium or discount, revaluation surplus, revenue
and capital reserves and retained earnings.

(h) Liabilities: Disclosure of applicable rates, repayment terms, and covenants on long term
liabilities such as secured and unsecured loans, loans from holding, subsidiary and
associated companies.

Current liabilities disclosing separately: amounts due to holding/subsidiary and associated


companies, trade creditors, other creditors, accrued expenses, dividends payable, taxation ,
bank loans and overdraft.

27
3.4.3 Profit and Loss Account/Income and Expenditure Account

The profit and loss account with related notes or Income and Expenditure Account (in the
case of a company or organisation, not trading for profit), should disclose the following
information:

(a) Turnover / Sales distinguishing between local and export sales.

(b) Other Operating Revenue – for example rental income or exchange gain

(c) Other Earnings – distinguishing between interest income; income from investments and
other sources:

(d) Cost of sales

(e) Gross profit

(f) Selling and distribution expenses

(g) Administration expenses

(h) Interest charges

(i) Taxes on income; and

(j) Abnormal or exceptional items (income items or expenditure, which although unusually,
are within the normal trading activities of the business). Examples are:
1. abnormal charges for bad debts and “write-offs” of stocks;
2. abnormal provision for losses on long-term contracts;
3. most adjustments of prior year taxation provisions; and
4. Shortfalls on actuarial valuation of gratuity scheme liabilities.

(k) Extra – ordinary items: outside the ordinary activities of the business and expected not to
recur frequently or regularly. Examples of extra-ordinary items are profits or losses
arising from:
1. The discontinuance of a significant part of a business.
2. The sale of an investment not acquired with the intention of resale.
3. Writing off intangibles, such as goodwill, because of unusual events or development
during the period; and
4. The expropriation of assets

(l) Profit before taxation.

(m) Proposed Dividend.

(n) Profit after Taxation.

(o) Earnings per share.

(p) Dividend per share

28
3.4.4 Notes to the accounts

The financial statements should be accompanied by explanatory notes to the figures in the
Balance Sheet, Profit and Loss Account and Cash Flow Statement.

The CAMA specifically requires the disclosure of the following information in the notes to
the accounts:

(a) Directors’ emoluments stating Chairman’s emoluments, highest paid Director’s


emoluments, Directors’ fees, other emoluments; and number of directors earning within a
stated band of Emoluments.

(b) Auditors’ Remuneration.

(c) Depreciation charged on fixed assets.

(d) Number of employees and remuneration, stating average number of employees and
number of employees earning.

(e) Capital commitments stating value of capital expenditure authorised by the Board but not
executed as at balance sheet date. Amount committed out of the unspent amount should
also be disclosed.

(f) Contingent liabilities stating nature of the liabilities, and the Directors’ opinion on the
likely loss that may arise from the liability.

(g) Technical Service Agreement, stating amount payable for the period covered by the
financial statements.

(h) Post Balance Sheet events, stating the material effect the events will have on the financial
statements (if any).

3.4.5 Auditors’ report

A set of financial statements must contain a signed and dated audit report certifying that:

(a) The company’s books of accounts have been properly kept and proper returns for purpose
of audit have been received from branches not visited.

(b) The financial statements:


 are in agreement with the books of accounts;
 give a true and fair view of the company’s affairs;
 have been prepared in accordance w it h relevant, Statements of Accounting
Standards issued by the NASB; and
 have been properly prepared in accordance with the CAMA.

3.4.6 Directors’ report

Financial statements must contain a signed and dated report of the Board, highlighting the
following:

29
(a) Directors’ responsibilities in accordance with Sections 334 and 335 of CAMA.

(b) Principal activities of the company.

(c) Results of the company for the period and appropriation of the profits.

(d) Changes in the Board of Directors during the period.

(e) Directors’ interest in the company’s shares

(f) Directors’ interest in the company’s contracts.

(g) Major shareholdings disclosing shares held by individuals and organisations holding
more than 10% of the company’s issued share capital.

(h) Employment and employees highlighting:


 Employment of disabled persons.
 Employees’ health, safety and welfare
 Employees’ involvement and training

(i) Major suppliers and distributors of company’s materials and products respectively.

(j) Research and Development efforts of the company; and

(k) Donations and gifts by the company, stating organisations to which the company donated
and amount made available.

3.4.7 Audit committee’s report

In accordance with Section 359 (6) of the CAMA, every public company is required to
elect maximum of six members into the Audit Committee at every Annual General Meeting
to function until the next Annual General Meeting w hen fresh election is conducted.

Three of the members are elected by the shareholders and the remaining three elected by the
Board of Directors, among them.

The Audit Committee is required to:

(a) review the external auditors’ scope and planning of the audit requirements;

(b) review the external auditors’ memorandum of recommendations on accounting policies


and internal controls, together with management responses;

(c) ascertain that the accounting and reporting policies of the company are in accordance
with legal requirements and agreed ethical practices

(d) recommend to the Board with regard to the appointment, removal and remuneration of the
external auditors of the company; and authorise the internal auditor to carry out
investigations into any activities of the company which may be of interest or concern to
the committee

30
The Audit Committee is required to express an opinion on the adequacy or otherwise of the
matters stated above and that they are satisfied with the management responses to the external
auditors’ findings.

3.4.8 Cash flow statement

This provides information on the derivation and utilisation of funds during the period covered
by the financial statements.

A cash flow statement should disclose the following:

(a) Cash flows from Operating Activities

Profit before taxation for the period covered by the financial statements is appropriately
adjusted, for non-cash items such as:

 Depreciation and amortisation charge on fixed assets;


 Profit or loss on disposal of fixed assets; and
 Provision for unfunded pension plan.

(b) Changes In Current Assets And Liabilities

Increase or decrease in current assets and liabilities w hen compared to those in the
preceding year is accounted for under this sub-head to reflect:

(i) Increase or decrease in stock;


(ii) Increase or decrease in debtors and prepayments;
(iii)Increase or decrease in creditors and accruals; and
(iv) Increase or decrease in foreign currency deposit for imports.

(c) Payments in connection with operations, such as income tax and retirement benefits
paid during the period covered by the financial statements are deducted from the addition
of (a) and (b) above, before arriving at net cash inflow or outflow from operating
activities.

(d) Cash flow from Investing Activities

Actual cash outflows or inflows of the following, during the period covered by the
financial statements, are disclosed:

(i) Purchase of fixed assets, investment or intangible assets


(ii) Proceeds from sale of assets, investment or intangible assets; and
(iii)Dividends and interests received on investments.

(e) Cash flow from Financing Activities

Actual cash inflows or outflows on the following during the period covered by the
financial statements are disclosed:

(i) Dividends paid to shareholders.


(ii) Repayment of Debenture stock; and
31
(iii) Proceeds from issue of shares and Debenture stock.

(f) Movement in Net Liquid Funds

The net figure arrived at by pooling together all the net figures obtained in (a) – (e) above,
represents net increase or decrease in cash and cash equivalents. W hen cash and cash
equivalents at the beginning of the period covered by the financial statements are added to
the net increase or decrease, we arrive at cash and cash equivalents at the end of the
period covered by the financial statements which may consist of; Cash and bank balances,
Bank overdrafts; and Investments in commercial papers and other short-term financial
instruments.

3.4.9 Value Added Statement

Value-added statement reports the additional wealth created by an enterprise on its own and
by its employees’ efforts during the period covered by the financial statements. It usually
shows how the wealth created is distributed among various interest groups (such as,
employees, government, creditors, providers of capital and that retained for the future
creation of more wealth).

The statement shows separately, the following:

(a) Sales to outsiders (third parties outside the group);

(b) Purchases of goods and services; distinguishing between imported and local items;

(c) (a)less (b) above represents value added; and

(d) Distribution of Value-added to various groups such as Employees, Government –


company income and education taxes, Excise duties, Providers of finance, Retained for
the replacement of assets and business growth to provide for depreciation of fixed assets;
and augment reserves

3.4.10 Five- Year Financial Summary

The five–year financial summary enables an instant comparison of an enterprise’s activities


over the five-year period. Information to be disclosed is as follows:

a) Results: Turnover, Profit before tax, Taxation, Profit after taxation, Dividend, Retained
earnings.

b) Assets employed: Fixed Assets, Intangible Assets, Investments, Net Current Assets, Long
term liabilities and deferred charges.

c) Funds employed: issued share capital, Share premium, Revaluation Reserves and other
Reserves – Revenue, Bonus issue.

d) Financial Statistics: share price at the end of the period, earnings per share, dividend per
share, dividend cover, net worth per share, return on capital employed, current assets:
current liabilities.

32
Self Assessment Exercise 2.1

1. State any major difference between Auditor’s report and Audit Committee’s report.

2. Highlight one piece of information usually disclosed in the form of notes to the financial
statements that may not affect the figures in the accounts.

4.0 CONCLUSION

It is pertinent to note that financial statements are expected to be drawn up in conformity with
the Generally Accepted Accounting Principles, in accordance with the Statement of
Accounting Standards issued by the NASB, and in agreement with the books of accounts of
the entity.

5.0 SUMMARY

This unit explores the statutory framework guiding the contents of financial statements as
stipulated in the CAMA. Objectives of the various users of financial statements were
reviewed.

In the next unit, we shall study another interesting topic: preparation of published financial
statements.

6.0 TUTOR-MARKED ASSIGNMENT

1. Trace the history of CAMA 2004.

2. Explain one of the following items is highlighted by the chairman’s statement in a


company’s annual report.

a. Projections into the future as to how to improve on the company’s performance.


b. Discussions in the last annual general meeting only.
c. The significant development in the company in the past 6years only.

3. Which of the following items is found in a company’s profit and loss account?

a. Discontinuance of a significant part of a business


b. Writing off goodwill
c. Substantial loss sustained as a result of robbery attack.
d. Sale of an investment not acquired with the intention of resale
e. The appropriation of asset

7.0 REFERENCES/FURTHER READINGS

Adapted from the ICAN Study Packs (2011)

Iornongu, C. (2009). Company Law. MBA 704 Study Material for NOUN Post Graduate
Students in the School of Management Sciences

33
UNIT THREE PREPARATION OF PUBLISHED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

CONTENTS

1.0 Introduction
2.0 Objectives
3.0 Main Content
3.1 Application of Financial Statements
3.2 Abridged Financial Statements
4.0 Conclusion
5.0 Summary
6.0 Tutor-Marked Assignment
7.0 References/Further Readings

1.0 INTRODUCTION

In the last unit, we explored the statutory framework guiding the contents of financial
statements as stipulated in the CAMA. We also reviewed the objectives of the various users
of financial statements.

In this unit, we shall examine the preparation of published financial statements.

2.0 OBJECTIVE

At the end of this unit, you should be able to prepare financial statements of limited liability
companies.

3.0 MAIN CONTENT

3.1 Preparation of Financial Statements

Having gone through the statutory framework required in preparing financial statements, the
best way to demonstrate its practical application is by working through illustrative examples.

Illustration 3-1

Samba Nigeria PLC is an Electrical Components assembly outfit with authorised and issued
share capital of N200 million, made up of 400 million ordinary shares of 50 kobo each. The
following is the company’s trial balance as at 30 April 2008.

PARTICULARS DR CR
N’000 N’000
Freehold land 25,000
Short term deposits 50,000
Sundry debtors 60,820
Cash and bank 50,862
Furniture and fitting – cost 44,720
Accumulated depreciation 11,180

34
Machinery and equipment-cost 164,000
Accumulated depreciation 32,800
Stock at 1 may 2003 27,160
Sundry creditors 39,420
Bank overdraft 25,000
Wages 97,280
Postages and telephone 2,100
General expenses 6,060
Bad debts written off 560
Auditors remuneration 2,000
Distribution expenses 2,140
Insurance 2,060
Bank interest paid and received 4,100 1,000
Electricity 3,800
Salaries (including directors remuneration 76,850
N2m)
Rates 1,580
Purchases 306,832
Sales 640,124
Dividends(interim) 24,000
Profit and loss account 2,400
Share capital _______ 200,000
951,924 951,924

The following adjustments are necessary for the year ended 30/4/2008:

(a) The directors recommended that 5% of debtors should be set aside for possible bad debt.

(b) Stock w as valued at N28,648,000 as at 30 April, 2008.

(c) W ages outstanding at 30 April, 2008 amounted to N 2,400,000 and electricity accrued w
as N280,000.

(d) Depreciation is to be written off machinery and equipment at 10% per annum and
Furniture and Fittings at 5% per annum.

(e) The Sales Manager is entitled to sales commission of 2% of gross profit. The commission
is payable on 1 May, 2008.

(f) Insurance has been paid in advance amounting to N 285,000.

(g) Machinery which stood in the books at 1 May, 2007 at N 8million has been sold for N6
million in part exchange for a new machinery costing N 12 million. A net invoice for N6
million has been posted into the Purchases account. No other entry has been made in
respect of this transaction. The original cost of the old machinery was N 10million. It is
the company’s policy to charge a full year’s depreciation in the year of purchase and none
in the year of sale.

(h) The Directors proposed a final dividend of 8%, making a total of 20% dividend in respect
of the year to 30 April, 2008.
(i) Provision for company income tax w as N 35million.
35
You are required to prepare the profit and loss account for the year ended 30 April, 2008 and
balance sheet as at 30 April, 2008 in a form suitable for publication. Notes to the accounts are
not required but you should show your workings.

Suggested Solution 3-1


SAMBA NIGERIA PLC
PROFIT AND LOSS ACCOUNT FOR THE YEAR ENDED 30 APRIL 2008
Workings N’000 N’000
Turnover 640,124
Cost of sales 1 (399,024)
Gross profit 241,100
Selling and distribution expenses 2 6,962
Administration expenses 3 118,882 (125,844)
Trading profit 115,256
Interest income 1,000
116,256
Interest payable and similar charges (4,100)
Profit before taxation 112,156
Taxation (35,000)
Profit after taxation 77,156
Interim dividend paid 24,000
Final dividend proposed (8% x N200,000) 16,000 (40,000)
Retained profit for the year 37,156
Earnings per share of 50kobo 4 19kobo
Dividend per share of 50kobo 10kobo

SAMBA NIGERIA PLC


BALANCE SHEET AS AT 30 APRIL 2008
Workings N’000 N’000
Fixed assets 5 174,904
Current assets:
Stock 28,648
Debtors and prepayments 6 58,064
Short term deposits 50,000
Cash and bank balances 50,862
187,574
Current liabilities (amounts falling due within one year)
Creditors and accrual
Bank overdrafts 7 (97,922)
(25,000)
Net current assets N(187,574– 122,922) (122,922)
NET ASSETS 64,652
239,556
Financed by:
CAPITAL AND RESERVES
Share capital
400,000 ordinary shares of 50kobo each 200,000
Revenue reserve 39,556
Shareholders’ fund 8 239,556
36
Workings
1. Cost of sales N’000
Opening stock 27,160
Purchases (N306,832 – N 6,000) 300,832
327,992
Less: closing stock 28,648
299,344
Wages N (97,280 + 2,400) 99,680
399,024
2. Selling and distribution expenses:
Distribution expenses 2,140
Selling expenses – sales manager’s commission
N (2% of gross profit of 241,100) 4,822
6,962

3. Administration expenses
Salaries 76,850
Bad debts N (60,820 x 5%) +560 3,601
Depreciation charge – P&M
N (164,000 – 10,000)+ 12,000) x 10% 16,600
Furniture and fittings N (44,720 x 5%) 2,236
Insurance N (2,060 -285) 1,775
Loss on disposal of machinery N (8,000 – 6,000) 2,000
Electricity N (3,800 +280) 4,080
Postages and telephone 2,100
General expenses 6,060
Rate 1,580
Auditor’s remuneration 2,000
118,882

4. Earnings per share = Profit after tax = 77,156 x 100 = 19.29kobo


No of issued shares 400,000

5. Fixed assets
Freehold land Furniture & Machinery Total
Fittings & Equipment
COST N’000 N’000 N’000 N’000
At 1 may 2007 25,000 44,720 164,000 233,720
Addition - - 12,000 12,000
Disposal - - (10,000) (10,000)
At 30 April 2008 (a) 25,000 44,720 166,000 235,720

Depreciation
At 1 may 2007 - 11,180 32,800 43,980
Charge for the year - 2,236 16,600 18,836
Loss on disposal - - (2,000) (2,000)
(b) - 13,304 47,400 60,816
Net book value
At 30 April 2008 (a-b) 25,000 31,304 118,600 174,904

37
6. Debtors and prepayments N’000
Sundry debtors 60,820
Less: provision for bad debts 3,041
57,779
Prepaid insurance 285
58,064

7. Creditors and accruals:


Sundry creditors 39,420
Accrued sales manager’s commission 4,822
Accrued wages 2,400
Accrued electricity 280
Taxation 35,000
Proposed final dividend 16,000
97,922
8. Revenue reserve
Balance brought forward 2,400
Retained profit for the year 37,156
39,556

3.2 Abridged Financial Statements

Annual reports and financial statements are the means of communicating to the shareholders
and other interested parties information on the financial resources, obligations and
performance of a reporting entity or enterprise.

Annual report refers to the Chairman’s statement, Directors’ report, Auditors’ Report, Audit
Committee’s Report , information communicated on Accounting Policies, Balance Sheet,
Profit and Loss Account (Income statement), Cash flow Statement, Value Added Statement,
Notes on the accounts, Five-year Financial Summary, and Notice of Annual General
Meeting. Such a report usually assists shareholders and other interested parties in assessing
the financial, liquidity, profitability and viability of an enterprise.

In recent years, groups of shareholders and some companies in Nigeria aim to reduce the size
of annual reports and financial statements, and curtail the cost of printing and mailing the
glossy information.

Section 355 of the CAMA allows companies to publish abridged financial statements. The act
does not specify any minimum disclosure requirement of such statements.

3.2.1 SAS 20 – Abridged Financial Statements

The objectives of Statement of Accounting Standard No. 20 are:

 to specify the minimum contents of abridged financial statement.


 to standardize formats for presentation of abridged financial statements; and
 to improve comparability and usefulness of abridged financial statements.
Abridged financial statements should carry a declaration that:

 they are abridged financial statements;

38
 the financial statements and specific disclosures included in them have been derived from
the financial statements of the company

 the abridged financial statements cannot be expected to provide understanding of the


financial performance, financial position, financing and investing activities of the
organisation as the full financial statements; and

 copies of the full financial statements can be obtained from the Registrars of Companies.

Abridged financial statements should include the following, as in the full financial
statements:

(i) Accounting policies;


(ii) Profit and Loss Account for the financial year;
(iii) Balance sheet as at end of the financial year;
(iv) Statement of cash flows for the financial year;
(v) Notes in relation to exceptional and extra-ordinary items
(vi) Five-year financial summary; and
(vii) Any other information necessary to ensure that the abridged financial statements are
consistent with the full account sand reports of the year.

Other information to be included in abridged financial statements is:

(i) Notice of Annual General Meeting;


(ii) Names of Directors during the year and their shareholding;
(iii)Report of the audit committee, which should confirm that the auditors’ report is
unqualified
(iv) Financial Highlights (Results at a glance); and
(v) Dividends paid or proposed and date of payment
 A company w hose auditors’ report on the financial statement for a period are
qualified should not publish abridged financial statements for that period.

3.2.2 Disclosure Requirements

The following information should be disclosed in abridged financial statements:

1) Material events occurring after the balance sheet date and where there is a change in
accounting policies or estimates from those used in the preceding financial year or is
expected to have a material effect in a subsequent financial year, the information about
such change in accordance with SAS No 6, on extra ordinary items and prior year
adjustments.

2) Where a company is a parent company, the statement in above applies to the consolidated
financial statements of the company and the accompanying notes, and does not require
that the parent company’s own financial information be provided information for the
preceding financial year, which corresponds to the disclosures made in accordance with
this standard for the current financial year, should be disclosed.

3.3 Self Assessment Exercises

In what way are extraordinary and exceptional items different?


39
4.0 CONCLUSION

Companies in Nigeria are allowed to publish abridged financial statements under section 355
of CAMA 2004 cap c20 LFN 2004. Such statements should comply with the requirements of
SAS 20.

5.0 SUMMARY

As a follow up to the regulatory framework in the earlier unit, practical application of the
theoretical background on the preparation of financial statements on limited liability
companies, including relevant notes to the financial statements in the recommended formats
has been shown.

In the next unit, we shall treat the topic preparation of a cash flow statement.

6.0 TUTOR-MARKED ASSIGNMENT

List any two disclosures required in notes to the financial statements in respect of directors’
emoluments.

7.0 REFERENCES/FURTHER READINGS

Adapted from the ICAN Study Packs (2011)

Iornongu, C. (2009). Company Law. MBA 704 Study Material for NOUN Post Graduate
Students in the School of Management Sciences.

40
UNIT FOUR PREPARATION OF A CASH FLOW STATEMENT

CONTENTS

1.0 Introduction
2.0 Objectives
3.0 Main Content
3.1 Basic Principles Governing the Preparation of Cash Flow Statements and the
Approved Formats
3.2 Formats of Cash Flow Statement
4.0 Conclusion
5.0 Summary
6.0 Tutor-Marked Assignment
7.0 References/Further Readings

1.0 INTRODUCTION

In the last unit, we undertook practical application of the theoretical background on the
preparation of financial statements on limited liability companies, including relevant notes to
the financial statements in the recommended formats.

In this unit, we shall examine the steps to be taken in preparing a cash flow statement.

2.0 OBJECTIVES

At the end of this unit, you should be able to:

 Understand the basic principles and formats of cash flow statements; and
 Undertake Practical application and analysis of cash flow statements of limited liability
companies.

3.0 MAIN CONTENT

3.1 Basic Principles Governing the Preparation of Cash Flow Statements and the
Approved Formats

Statement of Accounting Standards No. 18 (SAS) deals with the approved format for
preparing statement of cash flows.

A statement of cash flows provides information about the cash receipts and payments of an
enterprise over a given period. It indicates the pattern of cash generation and utilization. It
also reveals how cash is generated from operations through new capital raised and how it is
disbursed for capital expenditure, taxes, dividends to investors, new investments and debt
repayments. It is designed to shed light on an enterprise’s financial strength and illuminate
the balance sheet and profit and loss account.

3.1.1 Usefulness of a Cash Flow Statement

1. Assess the impact of its transactions; that is, operating, investing and financing activities
of its performance and financial position.

41
2. Assess the ability of an enterprise to meet its debt obligations, pay dividends and meet
other claims.

3. Assess the ability of an enterprise to finance on-going operations and growth from
internal sources and determine the amount of external financing required.

4. Reconcile Profit or Loss and net cash flows; and

5. Assess the ability of the enterprise to generate positive net future cash flows

3.1.2 Preparation of a cash flow statement

In line with the provisions of this Standard:

(a) The statement of cash flows should include all cash inflows and outflows of the
enterprise, during a reporting period. It should, however, exclude cash inflows arising
from the purchase and liquidation of cash equivalents.

(b) An enterprise should report its cash flows according to the activity which gave rise to
them and they should be grouped under the broad headings of operating, investing and
financing activities.

(c) An enterprise should adopt either the direct or indirect method in preparing its statement
of cash flow
 Direct method highlights cash received from customers, payments made to suppliers,
employees, tax authority etc.

 Indirect method arrives at cash inflow/outflow from operating activities by stating the
profit and loss before taxation, which is adjusted for items not involving movement of
funds such as depreciation charge, provision for doubtful debt, profit on sale of fixed
assets, and net changes in working capital, debtors, creditors, stock between the
current and the preceding years.

(d) Interest paid should be classified as cash flow from financing activities while interest
received should be classified as cash flow from investing activities, under direct method.
The interest element of finance lease rental payments should be shown separately by the
lessees; and statement of cash flows.
 Dividends received should be classified as cash flows from investing activities except
in cases where the investor company has significant influence over the Investee
Company and holds at least 20% of the equity. Here, dividend received should be
classified under operating activities.

 Dividends paid and other distributions to owners should be classified as cash flows
from financing activities.

(e) Cash flows resulting from foreign currency transactions should be translated, using the
rates applicable at the time they occurred. A weighted average exchange rate for a period
should be used for translation, if the result is substantially the same as if the rates
applicable at the dates of the cash flow were used.

(f) Taxation
42
 The total amount of income taxes paid should be classified as operating cash outflow

 The net amount paid or received with respect to value-added tax or other sales taxes
should be shown separately as cash flows from operating activities.

 Taxes paid or refunds received in respect of capital profits such as capital gains tax
should be reported in line with the underlying transaction s giving rise to them.

3.2 Formats of Cash Flow Statement

3.2.1 Format for a Limited Liability Company

XYZ NIGERIA PLC


CASH FLOW STATEMENT
For the Year Ended 31 December 2004
2004
N N
Cash Flows from Operating Activities
Profits before taxation X
Depreciation of fixed assets X
Profit / {Loss} on disposal of fixed assets X
Net interest Expense / (Income)
X
Cash flow before changes in working capital X X
CHANGES IN WORKING CAPITAL
Increase / (Decrease) in stock and work in progress X
Increase / (Decrease) in debtors and prepayments X
Increase / (Decrease) in Creditors & accruals X X
Increase / (Decrease) in Gratuities & Retirement benefits X
X X
Tax paid (X)
Net cash flows from operating activities X X X

Cash Flows from Investing Activities


Interest received X
Purchase of fixed assets (X)
Proceeds on disposal of fixed assets X X
Net cash used in investing activities X X

Cash Flow from Financing Activities


Proceeds from sales of shares X
Dividend paid (X)
Interest paid (X) X
Net cash inflow/outflow in financing activities X X
Net Increase / (Decrease) in cash and cash equivalent X X
Cash and cash equivalents at January 1 X
Cash and cash equivalents at December 31 X X
Cash and cash equivalents comprise of:
Cash and bank balances X
Bank deposit X
43
Bank overdraft (X) X X

Illustration 4-1

The Balance Sheets of Chuks Plc as at 31 December 2007 and 2008 are given below:
2008 2007
N’000 N’000 N’000 N’000
Fixed Assets:
Land and buildings 3,585 3,470
Plant, equipment and 2,702 3,107
vehicles
6,287 6,577
Goodwill and patents 852 785
7,139 7,362
Currents Assets:
Stocks &work-in-progress 5,717 5,735
Debtors and prepayments 4,935 4,697
Cash and bank balances 465 115
(a) 11,117 (a) 10,547
Deduct: Current Liabilities
Creditors and accruals 2,795 2,672
Current taxation 895 985
Bank overdraft 272 705
Proposed dividend 637 505
(b) 4,599 (b) 4,867
Net Current Assets (a-b) 6,518 (a-b) 5,680
Deferred taxation (1,555) (1,545)
12,102 11,497
Represented by:
Capital and reserves: 4,400 4,400
Ordinary share capital 517 517
Share premium account 1,100 1,100
Other capital reserves 6,085 5,480
Revenue reserves 12,102 11,497

Notes to the accounts show that:

(a) Depreciation has been charged for year 2008 as follows: N


Land & Building 87,000
Plant, Machinery & Vehicles 600,000
Goodwill and Patents 23,000

(b) Plant sold during the year 2008 realised N40, 000. It was included at cost in the
balance sheet for year 2007 at N152, 000, with depreciation accumulated at N132,
000. The difference between realisation and written down value of the asset was in the
pro fit and loss account.

(c) The balance of profit for year 2008 after taxation charged and dividend appropriation
has been transferred to Revenue Reserve.

44
Further enquires revealed that during year 2008, the company made cash payment for
total dividend amounting to N927,000 and Income and Education taxes of N
1,130,000.

You are required to prepare a cash flow Statement for the year ended 31December
2008

Suggested Solution 4-1


CHUKS PLC
Cash Flow Statement for the Year ended 31 December 2008
N’000 N’000
Cash flow from operating activities:

Profit before taxation (w1) 2,714


Depreciation of fixed assets N (87+600+23) 710
Profit/loss on disposal of fixed assets (20)
Cash flow before changes in working capital 3,404

Changes in working capital


Decrease in stock 18
Increase in debtor (238)
Increase in creditors 123 (97)
Taxes paid (w5) (1,130)
Net cash from operating activities 2,177

Cash flows from investing activities

Purchase of fixed assets (202+212)(w2,3) (417)


Purchase of goodwill and patents (w4) (90)
Proceeds from disposal of fixed assets (w3b) 40
Net cash flow from investing activities (467)

Cash flows from financing activities


Dividend paid (w6) (927)
Net increase in cash and cash equivalents 783
Cash and cash equivalents of January 1(115-705) (590)
Cash and cash equivalents at December 31 193
Cash and cash equivalents comprise:
Cash and bank balances 465
Bank overdraft (272)
193
Workings
CHUKS PLC

1. PROFIT BEFORE TAXATION


N ‘000
Increase in revenue reserves (N 6,085-5,480) 605
Deferred tax charged for 2008 written back to P&LN (1555-1545) 10
Tax charge for the year (see w5) 1040
Dividends charged to P&L (see w 6) 1059
2714
45
2. Land and Buildings
N ‘000 N ‘000
Opening balance 3,470 depreciation change 87
Balance representing
Assets purchased 202 closing balance 3,585
3,672 3,672

3. (a) Plant and Machinery


N ‘000 N ‘000
Opening balance 3,107
(Disposal a/c).depr 132 depreciation change 600
Balance representing disposal a/c-cost 152
Purchases 215 closing balance 2,702
3,454 3,454

1. (b) Plant Disposal


N ‘000 N ‘000
Plant a/c- cost 152 plant a/c depreciation 132
Profit on sale 20 sales proceeds 40
172 172

2. Goodwill and Patents


N ‘000 N ‘000
Opening balance 785 depreciation change 23
Balance -
Goodwill purchased 90 closing balance 852
875 875

3. Taxation
N ‘000 N ‘000
Taxes paid- bank 1,130 opening balance 985
Closing Balance 895 charged to p&l1,040
2,025 2,025

4. Dividend
N ‘000 N ‘000
Dividends paid-bank 927 opening balance 505
Closing balance 637 charged to p&l a/c 1,059
1,564 1,564

Self Assessment Exercises

The purpose of cash flow statement is to ______________

46
(i) Provide information about cash receipts, cash payments over a given period.
(ii) Indicate the pattern of cash generation and utilization
(iii)Show the cash available at all times
(iv) Show the profit of an enterprise is related to its liquidity

(a) I only
(b) i, ii and iv only
(c) Iv only
(d) i, ii, iii only
(e) ii and iii and iv only

4.0 CONCLUSION

We have read in the unit that cash flow statements provide information about the cash
receipts and cash payments of an enterprise over a given period.

5.0 SUMMARY

This unit details the usefulness and format of cash flow statements of limited liability
companies in accordance with SAS 18. Preparation of cash flow statements which adopt the
direct and indirect methods for companies was illustrated.

In the next unit, we shall discuss another topic, analysis and interpretation of financial
statements.

6.0 TUTOR-MARKED ASSIGNMENT

1. List two objectives of preparing cash flow statements

2. State one source of cash generated from operating activities

7.0 REFERENCES/FURTHER READINGS

Adapted from the ICAN Study Packs (2011)

47
UNIT FIVE ANALYSIS AND INTERPRETATION OF FINANCIAL
STATEMENTS

CONTENTS

1.0 Introduction
2.0 Objectives
3.0 Main Content
3.1 Nature and Objectives of Accounting Ratios
3.2 Ratio Analysis
3.3 Limitations of Ratio Analysis
3.4 Computation and Interpretation of Accounting Ratios
3.5 Value Added Statements
3.6 Report Writing
4.0 Conclusion
5.0 Summary
6.0 Tutor-Marked Assignment
7.0 References/Further Readings

1.0 INTRODUCTION

In the last unit, we undertook practical application of the theoretical background on the
preparation of financial statements on limited liability companies, including relevant notes to
the financial statements in the recommended formats.

In this unit, we shall examine the steps to be taken in preparing a cash flow statement.

2.0 OBJECTIVES

At the end of this unit, you should be able to:

 Undertake detailed analysis, usefulness and limitation of significant accounting ratios;


 Interpret ratios when computed; and
 Write financial report.

3.0 MAIN CONTENT

3.1 Nature and Objectives of Accounting Ratios

An Accounting ratio is a proportion or fraction or percentage, expressing a relationship


between one item in a set of financial statements and another item in the same financial
statements.

For example, the relationship between gross profit and sales is expressed by the accounting
ratio know n as “gross profit %” or gross margin, which is, computed as follows:

Gross Profit % = Gross profit x 100 = y%


Sales

When preparing financial statements, the objective is to convey information to the readers
and others who are interested parties with diverse interests.
48
The matters which are likely to concern these parties, varying according to emphasis, are:

(a) Profitability
(b) Liquidity
(c) Management efficiency
(d) Gearing
(e) Financial stability
(f) Investment appraisal.

The essence of any interpretation of financial statements is comparison. Comparison of the


current figures of a company with its own past performance, and with its budget or forecast.
Also, comparison with the performance of other companies in similar trades or industries. For
a potential shareholder, a broader comparison between companies involved in completely
different trades may be necessary.

In order to facilitate this comparison, it is customary to express figures in ratios or


percentages, so that a disparity in size between two businesses does not prevent comparison
of their results.

Ratio analysis is a most important device for interpreting the performances of companies
from their financial statements. Other tools used in the analysis and interpretations of
financial statements include:

(a) Cash flow statements (b) Value added statement.

3.2 Ratio Analysis

Each of the areas of interest highlighted in 5.1 above, will now be examined in detail, using,
where possible, the following specimen set of accounts

Illustration 5-1
ABC PLC
BALANCE SHEET AS AT 31 DECEMBER 2008
N’000 N’000 N’000
FIXED ASSETS (at cost less depreciation 260,000
CURRENT ASSETS:
Stock (opening stock N50 million) 60,000
Debtors 90,000
Cash 10,000
160,000

CURRENT LIABILITIES
Trade Creditors 40,000
Other liabilities 40,000 80,000
Net current assets 80,000
NET ASSETS 340,000

FINANCED BY:
Share capital
100million ordinary shares of N 1 each 100,000
20million preference shares of N 1 each 20,000
49
120,000
Revenue reserve 80,000
200,000
LOAN CAPAITAL
DEBENTURE STOCK 140,000
340,000

ABC PLC
PROFIT AND LOSS ACCOUNT FOR THE YEAR ENDED 31 DECEMEBER 2008
N’000
Turnover 600,000
Cost of sales (450,000)
Gross profit 150,000
Admin and distribution expenses (116,500)
Profit before interest and taxation 34,000
Debenture interest payable (7,400)
Profit before tax 26,600
Taxation (10,600)
Profit after tax 16,000
Preference dividend (1,000)
15,000
Ordinary dividend (10,000)
Retained profit 5,000

3.2.1 Profitability

Profitability may be expressed in relation to capital employed (profit as a percentage of assets


used to earn that it) or in relation to sales (gross or net profit as a percentage of sales).

(a) Return on Capital Employed (ROCE)


This is perhaps the most important ratio in assessing a company’s performance. It is
simply profit, expressed as a percentage of capital employed. In ratio analysis, the analyst
simply obtains the profit figure from the Profit & Loss Account and the capital employed
from the Balance Sheet.

(b) Return on Sales


(i) Gross Profit Percentage
The percentage of gross profit on sales can be calculated only if a trading account is
available. Fluctuations in it can be very informative, especially if a fixed mark-up on
cost, is used to arrive at selling prices.

150,000 = 25%
600,000

(ii) Net Profit Percentage

34,000 = 5.7%
600,000

50
This is a useful yardstick for comparing results of a company against its performance in
previous years or those of other companies in similar trade. This ratio discloses something
about the company’s sales philosophy.

(c) Asset turnover


Sales = 600,000 =1.8 times
Capital employed 340,000

A low rate shows that the company is not generating sufficient volume of business for the
size of the assets invested. This may be rendered by attempting to increase sales or by
disposing of some assets or both.

3.2.2 Liquidity

The standard measures are:

Current ratio: current assets = 160,000 =2:1


Current liabilities 80,000

Acid test or quick test: current assets – stock= 100,000= 1.25:1


Current liabilities 80,000

When interpreting liquidity ratios, you should bear the following points in mind.

1. Companies and trades vary in their working capital requirements (working capital is
current assets less current liabilities). A retail company does not have to invest capital in
stocks and debtors, in the way that a manufacturing company probably does.

The current ratio might be anything from about 1.4:1 up to may be 3:1, depending on the
trade. Be wary of statement that the “ideal ratio should be 2:1. The liquid ratio is,
however, expected to have a value not less than 1:1, otherwise the company could have
difficulty in meeting its debts as they fall due.

2. An unnecessarily high ratio may indicate that the company is not using its resources
efficiently. or the company has built up its current assets at the balance sheet date for a
major project, or seasonal sales, which is to begin shortly afterwards.

3. Many blue chip companies rely on bank overdraft as a permanent source of finance,
although often times stated as part of their current liabilities. This may w ell give rise to
very low current and liquid ratios, although no liquidity problem as such exists.

There is need to know the terms of the overdraft and the amount of the facility, so that
one could form a more reasoned conclusion.

4. Current and liquid ratios imply an immediate conversion of assets into cash and an
immediate settlement of current liabilities. This may not be the real problem. Only a cash
flow projection would produce an exhaustive answer to an analysis of working capital.

51
3.2.3 Management Efficiency

Here, the skills with which management looks after the assets, under its control, especially
stock, debtors, and the use of cash to pay its creditors control, especially stock, debtors, and
the use of cash to pay its creditors are analysed. The following ratios are relevant and
frequently expressed in terms of days.

For example, number of days credit given = Trade debtors *365


Credit sales

(a) Stock ratios

1. Raw materials stock holding = raw material stock * 365


Annual raw material consumption

2. Number of days work-in-progress = work in progress * 365


Annual cost of sales

3. Number of days sales covered by finished goods= finished goods stock * 365
Annual cost of sales

Information is inadequate to calculate these three ratios separately for ABC PLC, but it may
still be relevant to calculate the overall stock ratio, also called stock turnover period.

Stock ratio: Stock * 365 = 60,000 = 49 days


Cost of sales 450,000

The significance of these ratios is in the detection of undesirable upward trend in stock levels
and in evaluating relative management efficiency by comparing them with those in similar
companies.

(b) Debtors ratio

Trade debtors * 365 = 90,000 * 365 = 55 days


Credit sales 600,000

Trade debtors should be net of provision for bad and doubtful debts, if the figure is given.
There is assumption all the debtors are trade debtors and that all sales are credit sales.

Another problem which may also affect the stock and creditors ratio is that we may be
dealing with a seasonal trade and those debtors are abnormally high or abnormally low at the
balance sheet date. In this case, it may be more informative to take the average debtors level,
or better still, compare debtors at the balance sheet date with actual sales of the months
immediately, if known.

Assuming no abnormal factors, a figure of about 60 days (2 months credit) is regarded as


satisfactory for debtors’ ratio.

(c) Creditors ratio

52
Trade creditors * 365 = 40,000 *365 = 32 days
Credit purchase 460,000

Credit Purchases is arrived at thus: cost of sales+ closing stock –opening stock N(450+60-50)
This ratio appears to indicate very prompt settlement of creditors subject to special factors
discussed for debtors in 3.2.3

3.2.4 Gearing

Capital Gearing is the term used to describe the extent to which a company’s total capital is
provided by fixed interest securities, such as debentures.

For example, Ordinary Share Capital N 100,000


Loan Capital N 900,000

This ratio is expressed as:

Loan capital: 9/1 or 9:1


Equity capital

Loan capital * 100: 9/10 * 100 = 90%


Total capital

This is a high gearing situation in which N 100, 000 worth of equity capital controls N
1million of total capital.

Preference shares + debentures = 160,000 = 0.9:1


Ordinary shares + reserves 180,000

Fixed interest capital = 160,000 = 47%


Total capital 340,000

The ratio above reveals a moderate gearing situation for m any companies.

Gearing ratio is important for two reasons. First, it is one measure of risk being taken by an
equity investor.

Secondly, it assists a prospective lender, who may hesitate before lending a company more
than (say) twice the equity stake in it.

The borrowing powers of a company are frequently restricted by its Articles of Association.

3.2.5 Financial Stability

Tangible Net Asset value per share: that is Net Worth per share. This is calculated by
dividing the net tangible assets by the number of ordinary shares in issue. Care has to be
taken to exclude goodwill (an intangible asset) and to deduct the preference shares before
arriving at the figure of net tangible asset s attributable to the ordinary shareholders.

Assuming no goodwill in the illustration, the net tangible assets of AB PLC are:

53
N’000 N’000
Fixed assets 260,000
Net current assets 80,000
340,000
Less: loan capital 140,000
Preference capital 20,000 160,000
180,000.
Net tangible assets

In this case, the net tangible asset is the same as the ordinary share capital (N 100 million)
plus the reserve (N 80 million): but this is a shortcut, which will not always work in a more
complex set of figures. The asset value per share is, therefore:

180,000,000 *100 = 180kobo


100,000,000

The importance of assets per share figure is that it provides a “long step” that is, realisable
value per share if the company ceases operations. It is unlikely that the assets will realise
their balance sheet values exactly, a fact which partly explains the differentials between a
quoted companies’s net worth per share and its share market price.

3.2.6 Investment Appraisal

A prospective or an existing investor will look at the following to made decisions about
buying or selling shares in a company:

a. Earnings per share price


b. Earnings ratio
c. Dividend yield, and
d. Dividend cover.

(a) Earnings Per Share (EPS)

SAS 21 underlines its importance and explains the factors involved in arriving at it. Earnings
per share refer to earnings per ordinary share. It’s calculated by dividing the operating profit
after tax of a company for a financial year by the number of issued ordinary shares of the
company.

Operating profit or loss after income tax is the figure before extra ordinary items and after
applicable income tax expense.

Basic EPs: profit after tax and preference dividend = 100 *15,000 =15k/share
Ordinary share capital 100,000

(b) Price Earnings Ratio:

As the name implies, this ratio measures the relationship between earnings per share and the
market price per share.

In ABC PLC, the market price is not given, but assumes that the market value is the same as
the par value of each ordinary share.
54
Basic EPS = 100k
15k = 6.7 times

The significance of P/E ratio of a particular company can only be judged only in relation to
the other ratios of other companies in the same kind of business.

A P/E ratio higher than that of other comparative companies, on the other hand, indicates
greater demand for the company’s shares presumably because a rapid growth in earnings is
expected.

(c) Dividend Yield

This measures the return to a shareholder on the amount of his investments. In the case of a
quoted share, the yield is calculated by reference to the current market value.

Dividend yield = gross dividend per share = 10 * 100 = 10%


Market value per share 100

Since income is an important aspect of an investment for most investors, the dividend yield is
key criterion.

(d) Dividend Cover

The shareholder is interested in knowing whether his investment will continue to yield his
required return. For this reason, dividend cover is appropriate since it indicates the amount of
profit cover for an ordinary dividend and the amount of profit retained in the business:

Dividend cover= net profit for the year after interest and preference dividend
Dividend on ordinary shares
15,000 = 1.5 times
10, 000

3.3 Limitations of Ratio Analysis

In spite of the obvious benefits of ratio analysis, there are some limitations to the usefulness
of ratios. They include the following:

(a) The major limitation arises from the fact that they draw historical information which is of
little use in assessing future prospects of a company.

(b) Ratios are quantifiable data. They cannot provide non-quantifiable information like
competence of management and staff and changes in the operating environment.

(c) Some of the ratios, for example, do not have universally accepted uniform parameters.

(d) When carrying out inter-company analysis, different accounting policies adopted by the
companies could distort ratios calculated.

55
3.4 Computation and Interpretation of Accounting Ratios

Illustration 5-3

The balance sheet of funfair limited, a toy manufacturer, as at 31 December 2008 was as
follows:
N’000 N’000
FIXED ASSETS (NET) 12,000
Investments 500
Goodwill 1,900
14,400
CURRENT ASSETS
Stocks & work in progress 11,900
Debtors 11,700
Bank and cash balances 300
23,900

DEDUCT: CURRENT LIABILITIES


Creditors 8,900
Bank overdraft 7,200
Tax payable 400
Dividends payable 700
17,200
NET CURRENT ASSETS 6,700
NET ASSETS 21,100

FINANCED BY

CAPITAL AND RESERVES


Ordinary share capital- issued and fully paid 10,000
Revenue reserves 3,900
Shareholders’ fund 13,900
Deferred tax 1,200
Long term loan 6,000
21,100

Turnover during the year 2007 w as N 39million, (2006 - N 42million) and that in the first
half of 2008 w as N 12million (2007 - N 13million).

Stock at December 31, 2006 was N 2.1million. Stock is stated at cost (including appropriate
production overheads), which is approximately 60% of selling price.

Required:
(a) Compute the current ratio of Funfair Ltd at December 31, 2007.

(b) Briefly explain the purpose of current ratios and how it may vary with the nature of
the business concerned.

(c) What subsidiary ratios may usefully be computed which will enable an analyst to
form a judgement as to the working capital structure? Illustrate their computation
using the balance sheet and other data for Funfair Ltd.
56
(d) On the basis that turnover in 2007 was N 39million and debtors were N 11.7million,
the average collection period for Funfair Ltd w as 109.5days, which is clearly
excessive, comment on this analysis.

(e) Comment on the major weakness (apart from debt collection) apparent from the
accounts of Funfair Ltd.

Suggested Solution 5-3

a) Current Ratio =Current assets = 23.9 =1.39:1


Current liabilities 17.2

(i) Purpose of Current Ratio

The current ratio is an indicator of the financial soundness and stability of a business. The
priority of a business is survival and it cannot survive unless it is able to meet its debts as
they become due for payment.

By relating these two figures at a particular date, one can assess the company’s ability to pay
debts due within 12months, out of assets which are to be converted to cash in approximately
within the same time scale.

Current assets include stocks and work in progress. They are perhaps the most difficult assets
to convert quickly to cash. It is therefore, common to measure the company’s immediate
ability to pay its debt by computing the liquidity ratio or acid test ratio.

Acid test ratio: current assets less stock and work in progress= 23.9-11.9 = 12
Current liabilities 17.2 17.2

= 0.7:1

Attempts are frequently made to establish a norm for these ratios. It is difficult to state an
absolute figure in isolation, for example stock and debtors levels required in one industry
may be quite different from those in another.

The ratios should be compared year by year within the same company and one would look for
a consistent pattern. An industry average would be useful indicator for a company, as it
would enable comparison to be made with other companies in the same sector.

Ratios do not usually provide final answers; they only assist in the better understanding of
financial reports. It is, therefore, always necessary to relate the figures to previous
performance or some external standards.

(ii) Effects of the Nature of Business

The crucial effect of the nature of the business on the current ratio can be illustrated by
reference to two elements of working capital:

Stocks – Manufacturing companies hold stocks of raw materials, work-in-progress and


finished goods, whereas service companies tend not to do so.
57
Debtors – Businesses which sell for cash (such as Supermarkets will not have material figures
for trade debtors compared with businesses whose sales are principally on credit terms, for
example, heavy engineering firms.

Clearly, the current ratios in these types of operation are significantly affected by the nature
of the business and this clearly explains why it is essential to compare current ratios from
year to year within the same company or with other companies in the same industry.

b) Working Capital Ratios

It is possible to take an overall view of the level of working capital by computing ratios
which link working capital or its constituent elements to other aspects of the business. Having
established normal or desired relationships, one can monitor deviations from the norm. The
objective is to establish the causes and effects of these deviations (which may be justified).

(i) Working Capital= 6.7 = 0.32:1


Capital employed 21.1

Or Working Capital= 6.7 = 0.56:1


Fixed assets 12

The implication is that a high proportion of working capital to total capital employed , gives
the business freedom to adapt to changing circumstances, for example, it might enable a
company to boost sales by a temporary reduction of liquidity or to realise assets and invest
the proceeds in the most profitable way.

2007 2006
(ii) Stock Turnover Ratio = Sales 39 = 3.3 times 42 = 20times
Stock & WIP 11.9 2.1

By relating sales to year-end stocks and work-in-progress, the analyst who only has access to
published information, attempts to, assess the effectiveness of the company’s control over its
stock levels and its ability to generate sales in relation to stocks held.

Published information in this question is deficient in two principal aspects:

1. No Information is disclosed as to cost of goods sold. Such information would be useful in


computing stock turnover ratio, because sales include a profit element whereas stocks are
usually stated at cost. Comparisons between companies are distorted by the discrepancy
between gross profit margin earned by different businesses. It would therefore be better to
relate stocks to cost of goods sold.

2. No information is disclosed about the pattern of sales during the year, or about the
average levels of stocks held or about cost of goods sold.

In the example, w e can re-compute the ratio using cost of goods sold as being 60% of sales.

2007 2006
Cost of goods sold = 23.4 = 2.97 times 25.2 = 12times
Stock + WIP 11.9 2.1

58
(iii)Average collection period

Trade Debtors = N11.7m = 109.5 days


Sales per day N 106,850

Sales per day = N 106,850 (3.9m/365)

This ratio, w hen compared with those of previous years and with other similar companies,
indicates the effectiveness of the company’s credit control procedures and adverse
movements may suggest the inclusion of bad and doubtful debts in the trade debtors figure.
When calculated on the basis of published accounts, this ratio requires qualification.

c) Comment on the Average Collection Period

Funfair Ltd. has a collection period of 109.5 days based on annual turnover of N 39million
and year-end trade debtors of N 11.7million. This appears to be excessive, but like all ratios,
it must be related to other information. If other toy manufacturers have a similar collection
period, funfair’s 109.5days may appear very long, but that may be the norm for that industry.

This question provides information about the seasonal nature of the company’s business,
sales in the first half of 2007 w ere N 13million and doubled in the second half to N
26million (N 39m – N 13million).

For example, if it could be established that the company’s normal terms of credit were for
2months and that sales for the fourth quarter of 2007 were N 18million, w e could re-compute
the ratio as follows:

Sales per day over the last quarter = N 18m = N 200,000


90

Collection period = N 11.7m * 365 = 58.5 days


N 200,000

This calculation demonstrates that the collection period is almost exactly in line with the
company’s policy, whereas using the year-end debtor and annual turnover, the collection
period extends to 109.5days. This does not mean that credit control is not weak in Funfair
Ltd, but it is not possible from the published accounts of one year, to make a categorical
statement about control.

d) Major Weakness apparent from the accounts of Funfair Ltd.

The company is a toy manufacturer and one would have expected its stock levels to be
relatively low at its year-end, because of the seasonal nature of the business. At 31 December,
2006, stocks were valued at N 2.1 million and one year later, it had risen to N 11.9million.

This occurred in a year when turnover fell from N 42million to N 39million. One might
conclude that the company had been over-producing in 2007 and the Stock /Turnover ratio
based on year-end stocks and cost of goods sold, tends to give credence to that conclusion.

One possible explanation for building stocks at the year-end would be to meet expected
demand in the early months of the following year, perhaps to coincide with the launch of a
59
new product or an advertising campaign. However, it is unlikely to be the case with Funfair
Ltd, because its seasonal peak of sales would fall in the last quarter of the year and not in the
first quarter.

The question gives a sales figure of N 12million for the first 6 months of 2008. Provided that
cost represents the quoted 60% of selling price, the cost of goods sold in the period is N
7.2million. This suggests that the stocks valued at N 11.9million will easily last the company
until the second half of 2008.

Therefore, it is likely that the company will have to reduce production drastically in 2008, to
avoid holding excessive stocks, which are expensive to finance in terms of Bank overdraft
interest. Redundancies would be an inevitable consequence of major cuts in production and
this situation represents a serious threat to the future of the business.

3.5 Value Added Statement

Value-Added Statement represents the additional wealth which an entity has been able to
create by its own and its employees’ efforts. This statement shows the allocation of that
wealth among employees, providers of finance, government and that retained in the business
for future creation of more wealth.

Illustration 5-5
Set below is the profit and loss account of XYZ plc, a manufacturing company, for the year
ended 31 December 2008, together with its comparative figures.
2008 2007
N’000 N’000
Turnover 8,074,458 5,201,750
Cost of sales (5,015,397) (3,021,246)
Gross profit 3,059,061 2,180,513
Distribution costs (520,162) (364,475)
Administration expenses 1,366,742 (681,787)
Trading profit 1,172,157 1,134,251
Interest payable (net) (386,079) (235,739)
Profit before exceptional items and 786,078 898,512
taxation 113,169 -______
Exceptional items 672,909 898,512
(314,138) (335,520)
Taxation 358,771 562,992
Profit after taxation (351,000) (234,000)
proposed dividend 7,771 328,992
Retained profit

The following notes are relevant:

1. Included in cost of sales is excise duty amounting to N 2,095,631,000 (2007 N


1,028,900,000) charged on the manufactured goods

2. Included in Distribution and administration costs are staff salaries wages and fringe
benefits totalling N 495,872,000 (2007 N 306,062,000) and depreciation charged on
fixed assets of N200,264,000 (20 07- N 132,397,000)
60
3. Taxation comprises

2008 2007
N’000 N’000
Land & Building 34,982 314,479
Plant, Machinery & Vehicles 17,117 21,041
Goodwill and Patents 262,039 0_____
314,138 335,520

Required:
Prepare the statement of Value Added of the company for the year ended 31 December, 2008
as it will appear in its published financial statements.

Suggested Solution 5-5

XYZ PLC
STATEMENT OF VALUE ADDED FOR THE YEAR ENDED 31 DECEMBER 2008
2008 2007
N’000 % N’000 %
Turnover 8,074,458 5,201,759
Bought in materials and services (4,223,703) (2,600,149)
Value added; 3,850,755 100 2,601,610 100
Distribution of value added
To government:
Excise duty 2,095,631 54.4 1,028,900 39.6
Tax on company profit 52,099 1.4 335,520 12.9
To employees:
Salaries, wages and fringe 495,872 12.9 306,062 11.8
benefits
To providers of finance: 351,000 9.1 234,000 9.0
Dividends to shareholders 386,079 10.0 235,739 9.0
Interest on borrowings
Retained in business: 200,264 5.2 132,397 5.1
To maintain and replace fixed 7,771 0.2 328,992 12.6
assets 262,039 6.8 -______ 0-__
To augment reserves 3,850,755 100 2,601,610 100
Deferred taxation

3.6 Report Writing

Students sometimes presume that the interpretation of financial statements merely requires
the calculation of ratios; and consequently, ignore the aspect of report writing. The need to
change this notion, coupled with the need to improve communication skills of would be
accounting personnel in practice, industry and commerce, informs the specific inclusion of
this topic at this level of the professional examinations.

3.6.1 Elements of a Report

A good report usually consists of the following:

61
(a) Heading

A convenient format for examination use may be in internal memo form:

To: the directors, XYZ limited


From: Mr. Ade wazobia date
Subject _______________

The heading needs to give the names of the recipient and the writer, the date and the subject
been reported on.

In the absence of names, invent some, but do not use your own name.

(b) Terms of reference

Terms of reference are easily picked up by quoting from the question. Feel free to use a little
constructive imagination by referring to previous letters or meetings.

(c) Main body – Facts and Recommendations

 Use of appendices: In an accounting examination, candidates will probably have to make


some calculations perhaps ratios, proposals for amalgamation or absorption e.t.c. It is
advisable to attach the working sheet to your report as an appendix, and refer to the
appendix in the main report.

 Tabulation: In writing a report, or indeed in writing the answer to any non computational
question, the problem always arises as to whether to tabulate or not to tabulate. By
“tabulation”, we mean the presentation of information in a tabular form.

The advantages of tabulation are:

 English construction is simplified.


 It is easy to add to.
 It is easily marked when a number of factual points have to be dealt with; and
 It facilitates logical thought and presentation.

The disadvantages of tabulation are:

 If you can write good English, tabulation will limit your ability to demonstrate this to
the examiner.
 It is not suitable when an open question is to be discussed.

A reasonable compromise is probably to use tabulation for presenting facts and not opinions.
You should ensure that the form of each item in t he tabulation make sense with the
introduction.

 English style: a report should be written in clear, fairly formal English. Avoid pompous
business jargon, but on the other hand, avoid the over- colloquial approach. Use short and
simple sentences. It is probably better to report in the third person.

62
3.6.2 Qualities of a Good Report

A good report should have the following:

 Fullness: all aspects of the subject must be covered.

 Accuracy: information should be checked and verified.

 Literacy: grammatical correct sentences should be formed without ambiguity. Avoid split
infinitives and unnecessary abbreviations and slangs.

 Level/Consciousness of users: a report is for the readers; therefore jargons should be


avoided where possible.

 Interest of users: good English commands interest.

 Clarity of purpose: a report should be divided logically into parts and arrive at a
conclusion.

Written information can be narrative, tabulated or diagrammatic. The diagrammatic can be


further analysed into graphs, histograms, time series, bar charts, pictograms and pie charts.

Self Assessment Exercises

Price earnings ratio of a company measures_____________

(a) The relationship between Profit after tax and Market Price;
(b) The market value of the shares;
(c) Its earnings over the period under review;
(d) The relationship between earnings per share and market price per share;
(e) The relationship between dividends per share and market price per share.

4.0 CONCLUSION

Accounting ratios are of tremendous benefit in analysing and interpreting financial


statements. However, they have their own limitations.

5.0 SUMMARY

This unit demonstrates how accounting ratios are computed and interpreted. It is however
important to note that what is termed an ideal ratio varies from industry to industry and
sometimes on the size of the company.

In the next unit, you will be introduced to another topic titled contract account.

6.0 TUTOR-MARKED ASSIGNMENT

1. State two parties that are always interested in the interpretation of financial statements.
2. Mention one limitation of ratio analysis.

63
7.0 REFERENCES/FURTHER READINGS

Adapted from the ICAN Study Packs (2011)

64
UNIT SIX CONTRACT ACCOUNTS

CONTENTS

1.0 Introduction
2.0 Objectives
3.0 Main Content
3.1 Contract Account
4.0 Conclusion
5.0 Summary
6.0 Tutor-Marked Assignment
7.0 References/Further Readings

1.0 INTRODUCTION

In the last unit, we undertook practical application of the theoretical background on the
preparation of financial statements on limited liability companies, including relevant notes to
the financial statements in the recommended formats.

In this unit, we shall examine the steps to be taken in preparing a cash flow statement.

2.0 OBJECTIVES

At the end of this unit, you should be able to:

 Explain the two methods of accounting for contracts


 Determine profit under the two methods
 Compute the value of work in progress at the end of the period.

3.0 MAIN CONTENT

3.1 Contract Account

A construction contract is a contractual agreement between two parties, whereby a party


known as the contractee agrees to pay a specified consideration to the other party, known as
the contractor, for the execution of a specific project based on specified terms and conditions.

A construction contract is carried out for the execution of a project, which may be Civil,
Building, Engineering and so on. The period of execution may be within one year (short-term
projects), or spread over a period exceeding one year (long-term projects).

In accounting for construction contracts, SAS No 5: Accounting for Construction Contracts


recommends that every enterprise should use either the completed contract method or the
percentage of completion method.

3.1.1 Accounting for Short-term Projects

Short-term contracts are executed within a period of 12 months which may fall within one or
two accounting year-ends. Where such a contract is commenced and completed within an
accounting year-end, the resultant contract profit is recognized immediately in that
accounting year-end. Where the contract is commenced in one accounting year and
65
concluded in the next, then, there is the need to determine in which accounting year to
recognize such profit. There is also the need to determine the value of work-in-progress at the
end of the first accounting year in which the contract w as commenced but not completed.

The provision of SAS No 5: Construction Contracts on Short-Term Contracts is summarized


as follows:

(a) The Completed Contract Method should be used for short-term contracts

(b) Foreseeable Losses should be charged to the Profit and Loss account in the period in
which they are identified

(c) A contract should be regarded as completed, only when all activities relating to it are
accomplished. In a situation where the additional costs required to complete the contract
are not significant, provision should be made for such costs and the contract treated as
completed.

Illustration 6-1

Bojuboju Construction Limited undertook to build a plant for Tolu Manufacturing Limited, at
a contract price of N100,000. Expenditure relating to the contract are as follows:

N’000
Materials 30,000
Direct wages 40,000
Direct expenses 5,000
Plant @ cost 35,000
Plant hire 2,000
Sundry tools 3,000

The contract w as completed by the year ended 31 March, 2008, during which, the company
received N 60,000 from Tolu Manufacturing Ltd. The written down values of the plant and
tools were N 25,000 and N 500, respectively.

Required:
Prepare the contract account

Suggested Solution 6-1

BOJUBOJU CONSTRUCTION LIMITED


CONTRACT ACCOUNT FOR THE YEAR ENDED 31 MARCH 2008
N’000 N’000
Materials 30,000 Contract price 100,000
Direct wages 40,000 Plant(WDV) c/d 25,000
Direct expenses 5,000 Sundry tools 500
Plant at cost 35,000 (WDV)
Plant hire 2,000
Sundry tools 3,000
Contract profit taken 10500 ______
125,500 125,500

66
TOLU
MANUFACTURING LIMITED
CONTRACTEE N’000
Value of work ACCOUNT 60,000
certified N’000 Cash received 40,000
100,000 Contract debtor( 100,000
_______ bal c/d)
100,000

3.1.2 Accounting for Long-term Projects

There are special problems associated with accounting for businesses which carry out long
term construction contracts. These problems can be summarized as follows:

(a) These projects usually involve application of very substantial amounts of physical and
financial resources

(b) The production cycle can be very long in comparison with other businesses

(c) Profit recognition for each year of operation during the period of execution of the
contracts

3.1.3 Mode of operations

The following, are the methods of approach for a construction business:

(a) Resources are controlled on contract basis

(b) Each contract is given a separate identification code number and the costs of all
resources supplied to that contract are charged to it

(c) At intervals, throughout the period of the contract an approximation of the degree of
completion of each contract (in terms of the contract price) and a certificate to this
effect is issued by a qualified professional

(d) The certificates enable estimates to be made of the profit earned or loss sustained on
the contract up-to-date and also, of the value of the work-in-progress. Also the
certificates are the bases for a claim for interim payments (known as progress
payments).

(e) The contractor does not necessarily have to wait until the end of the contract period,
or receive payments, before recognising profits

(f) It is usual for the contractee to deduct withholding tax at source, from the progress
payments.

3.1.4 Accounting procedures

Separate ledger accounts are maintained, for each contract in which relevant costs are posted
and other relevant entries made for proper monitoring and management of each contract

67
3.1.5 Profit recognition

For each contract there is the need to determine the appropriate profit to be recognized. The
following are the acceptable methods of recognizing profit on construction contracts.

(a) Architect’s or Engineer’s certificate method.


(b) Percentage of completion method (SAS No 5)

3.1.6 Architect’s /engineer’s method

Under this method, each contract is debited with the costs of materials supplied, payments to
sub-contractors, w ages and contract overheads.

At the end of the period, the account is credited with architectural valuation, the value of
work done but not yet certified and the value of unused resources, such as materials at site,
and value of fixed assets at site. A credit balance on the account indicates a potential profit on
the contract, while a debit balance indicates a potential loss.

In accordance with the concept of prudence, it is recommended that any foreseeable loss
should be recognized immediately while estimated profit recognized systematically as below:

Profit recognised to date = estimated profit * 2/3 * cash received


Value of work certified

Illustration 6-2

Vulture Nigeria limited, undertakes to build another giant coal bunker for eastern coal
limited, at a contract price of N 150,000,000, estimating that the work will take 18 months to
complete. At the financial year ended 31 March 2008, the expenditure on the contract were as
follows:

N’000
Materials 30,000
Direct wages 40,000
Direct expenses 5,000
Plant @ cost 35,000
Plant hire 2,000
Sundry tools 3,000

The written down value of plant for the year ended 31march 2008, was 25,000,000 while the
value of sundry tools was estimated to be 500,000. At the year end, the value of work
certified was 100,000,000. While cash received from the customer amounted to 60,000.

Required:
Prepare the contract and contractee’s accounts, for the year ended 31 March 2008.

68
Suggested Solution 6-2

VULTURE NIGERIA LIMITED


CONTRACT ACCOUNT FOR THE YEAR ENDED 31 MARCH 2008

N’000 N’000
Materials 30,000 Plant(WDV) c/d 25,000
Direct wages 40,000 Tools (WDV) c/d 500
Direct expenses 5,000 Work in progress 93,700
Plant hire 2,000 (c/d)
Plant at cost 35,000
Tools at cost 3,000
Profit recognised 4,200 ______
119,200 119,200

EASTERN COAL
LIMITED N’000
Value of work CONTRACTEE Cash received 60,000
certified ACCOUNT Contract debtor( 40,000
N’000 bal c/d) 100,000
100,000
______
100,000

Workings:
1. computation of profit recognised
N’000 N’000
Value of work certified 100,000
Cost of work to date:
Material 30,000
Direct wages 40,000
Direct expenses 5,000
Plant hire 2,000
Plant @ cost 35,000
Sundry tools 3,000
115,000
Plant (WDV) c/d (25,000)
Tools (WDV) c/d (500)
89,500
Estimated profit 10,500

Profit to be recognised = 2/3 * cash received * estimated profit


Value of work certified
= 2/3 * 60,000,000 * 10,500,000
100,000,000
= N 4,200,000
Note:
 Cost of work certified, would have been used in calculating the estimated profit, if
provided
 This is a prudent approach to calculating profit recognised.
69
Alternative approach to calculating profit taken
Another acceptable approach is as follows:
= Cash received * estimated profit
Value of work certified

Therefore, profit = 60% * N 10,500,000

= N 6,300,000

3.1.7 Percentage of Completion Method (SAS 5)

This method is in line with provisions of SAS 5: construction contracts. It is applicable where
cost of completing the contract can be estimated with a degree of certainty.

Illustration 6-3

Given the details under illustration 6-2, vulture Nigeria limited, but with the following
additional information:

(a) It is estimated that the plant will have a written down value of N 15,000,000 at the end of
the contract, while the sundry tools will be valued at N 1,900,000.

(b) Estimated future cost to complete the contract are as follows:

N’000
Materials 13,000
Wages 25,000
Direct expenses 2,900
Sundry tools at cost 2,000
Required:

Prepare the contract account showing the profit taken.

Suggested Solution 6-3

VULTURE NIGERIA LIMITED


CONTRACT ACCOUNT FOR THE YEAR ENDED 31 MARCH 2008

N’000 N’000
Materials 30,000 Plant(WDV) c/d 25,000
Direct wages 40,000 Tools (WDV) c/d 500
Direct expenses 5,000 Work in progress 95,500
Plant hire 2,000 (c/f)
Plant at cost 35,000
Tools at cost 3,000
Profit recognised 6,000 _____
121,000 121,00

Workings:
1. computation of profit recognised
70
N’000 N’000 N’000
Contract price 150,000
Cost of work to date:
Materials 30,000
Direct wages 40,000
Direct expenses 5,000
Plant hire 2,000
(77,000)
Estimated future cost:
Materials 13,000
Wages 25,000
Direct expenses 2,900 (40,900)

Depreciation:
Plant N (35,000- 15000) 20,000
Tools N (3000+2000-1900) 3100
(23,100)
Estimated contract cost to completion (141,000)
Estimated profit 9,000

Attributable profit:
Value of work certified *estimated profit
Contract price

= 100,000,000 * 9,000,000
150,000,000

= N 6,000,000

Note: Future cost must be capable of being estimated with a degree of certainty.

3.1.8 Valuation of Work-in-Progress on Long-term Contracts

Under the provisions of SAS 5, the value of work in progress for balance sheet purposes is
calculated as follows:

N
Costs incurred to date X
Plus attributable profit–if any X
XX
Less foreseeable loss X
X
Less progress payments received
Or receivable X
Value of WIP for balance sheet X

Illustration 6-4

The following details are provided in respect of four contracts:

71
Sango Abule Pero igbesa
N N N N
Contract price 800,000 85,000 60,000 100,000
Cash received 450,000 76,000 - -
Value of work invoiced 500,000 80,000 - -
Cost of work certified 400,000 60,000 50,000 12,000
Estimated future costs 120,000 2,000 20,000 70,000
Cost to dates 400,000 60,000 55,000 13,000

You are required to:

(a) Calculate profit or loss to be taken on each contract;


(b) Show how the work in progress would be disclosed in the balance sheet.

Suggested Solution 6-4

A) contracts
Sango Abule Pero )igbesa
N N N N
Contract price 800,000 85,000 60,000 100,000

Costs to date 400,000 60,000 55,000 13,000


Estimated future costs 120,000 2,000 20,000 70,000
Estimated contract costs 520,000 62,000 75,000 83,000
Estimated profit/loss 280,000 23,000 (15,000) 17,000
Profit/loss taken 157,500 20,565 (15,000) -_____

B) work in progress (for balance sheet)

Cost to date: sango 400,000


abule 60,000
pero 55,000
igbesa 13,000
528,000
Add profit taken Sango 157,500
Abule 20,565
178,065
706,065
Less foreseeable losses: pero 15,000
691,065
Less progress payments:
Received: Sango 450,000
Abule 76,000
526,000
Receivable Sango (500,000 -450,000) 50,000
Pero (80,000 -760000 4,000
Igbesa 15,000
69,000
Construction work in progress 96,065
72
Workings:
1. profit or loss taken on projects:

Sango= N280,000* 500,000 * 450,000


800,000 500,000
=157,500
Abule = N23,000* 80,000 * 76,000
85,000 80,000
= N20,565
Pero = all foreseeable losses should be recognised immediately

Igbesa = N17,000* 15,000 * 0


100,000 80,000= nil

Self Assessment Exercises

1) A contract spanning over one year is called ______


(a) Construction contract
(b) Long term contract
(c) Short term contract
(d) Building contract
(e) Civil contract

2) Which of the following is not used in calculating work in progress at year end?
(a) Cost up to date
(b) Retention money
(c) Creditors balance
(d) Profit taken to profit and loss account
(e) Amount received or receivables

4.0 CONCLUSION

There are two acceptable methods for accounting for construction contracts. Also, there are
acceptable methods for profit determination.

5.0 SUMMARY

In the unit, the determination of work in progress for the balance sheet disclosure was
examined. The criteria stated in SAS 5 were also examined.

With the discussion of this unit, we have come to the end of the first module of this course.

6.0 TUTOR-MARKED ASSIGNMENT

1. Itemise one feature of a construction contract.


2. Differentiate between long term and short term contracts.

7.0 REFERENCES/FURTHER READINGS

Adapted from the ICAN Study Packs (2011)

73
MODULE TWO

Unit 1 Investment Accounting


Unit 2 Accounting for Lease and Hire Purchase
Unit 3 Accounting for Specialised Businesses
Unit 4 Generally Accepted Accounting Principles (GAAP)
Unit 5 Development, Contents and Application of Accounting Standards
Unit 6 Regulatory Framework of Financial Accounting

UNIT ONE INVESTMENT ACCOUNTING

CONTENTS

1.0 Introduction
2.0 Objectives
3.0 Main Content
3.1 Investment
3.2 Investment Account
3.3 Accounting Entries
3.4 Underwriter’s Account
3.5 Stock Brokerage’s Account
4.0 Conclusion
5.0 Summary
6.0 Tutor-Marked Assignment
7.0 References/Further Readings

1.0 INTRODUCTION

You are welcome to model two and unit one of this course.

In this unit, you will be introduced to investment accounting. This discussion will feature
investment account, accounting entries in investment account, underwriter’s account and
stock brokerage’s account.

2.0 OBJECTIVES

At the end of this unit, you should be able to:

 Explain the theoretical aspects of investment accounting;


 Prepare investment accounts.

3.0 MAIN CONTENT

3.1 What is Investment?

In simple terms, Investment refers to purchase of financial assets. While investment goods
are those goods, which are used for further production, they imply the production of new
capital goods, plants and equipments.

74
John Keynes refers investment as real investment and not financial investment.

3.1.1 Different Types of Investment

Different types or kinds of investment are discussed in the following points.

1. Autonomous Investment

Investment which does not change with the changes in income level is called as Autonomous
or Government Investment.

Autonomous Investment remains constant irrespective of income level. Which means even if
the income is low, the autonomous, Investment remains the same. It refers to the investment
made on houses, roads, public buildings and other parts of Infrastructure. The Government
normally makes such a type of investment.

2. Induced Investment

Investment which changes with the changes in the income level, is called as Induced
Investment.

75
Induced Investment is positively related to the income level. That is, at high levels of income
entrepreneurs are induced to invest more and vice-versa. At a high level of income,
Consumption expenditure increases this leads to an increase in investment of capital goods, in
order to produce more consumer goods.

3. Financial Investment

Investment made in buying financial instruments such as new shares, bonds, securities, etc. is
considered as a Financial Investment. However, the money used for purchasing existing
financial instruments such as old bonds, old shares, etc., cannot be considered as financial
investment. It is a mere transfer of a financial asset from one individual to another. In
financial investment, money invested for buying of new shares and bonds as well as
debentures have a positive impact on employment level, production and economic growth.

4. Real Investment

Investment made in new plant and equipment, construction of public utilities like schools,
roads and railways, etc., is considered as Real Investment. Real investment in new machine
tools, plant and equipments purchased; factory buildings, etc. increases employment,
production and economic growth of the nation. Thus real investment has a direct impact on
employment generation, economic growth, etc.

5. Planned Investment

Investment made with a plan in several sectors of the economy with specific objectives is
called as Planned or Intended Investment. Planned Investment can also be called as Intended
Investment because an investor while making investment makes a concrete plan of his
investment.

6. Unplanned Investment

Investment done without any planning is called as an Unplanned or Unintended Investment.


In unplanned type of investment, investors make investment randomly without making any
concrete plans. Hence it can also be called as Unintended Investment. Under this type of
investment, the investor may not consider the specific objectives while making an investment
decision.

7. Gross Investment

Gross Investment means the total amount of money spent for creation of new capital assets
like Plant and Machinery, Factory Building, etc. It is the total expenditure made on new
capital assets in a period.

8. Net Investment

Net Investment is Gross Investment less (minus) Capital Consumption (Depreciation) during
a period of time, usually a year. It must be noted that a part of the investment is meant for
depreciation of the capital asset or for replacing a worn-out capital asset. Hence it must be
deducted to arrive at net investment.

76
In today's complex world, investors need to make many important financial decisions,
including selecting investment accounts that best fit their particular style, needs and goals.

3.2 Investment Account

Account held at a financial facility for the purpose of a long term investment for capital
preservation, growth or fixed income. Financial facilities for investment accounts include
banks, insurance companies, and brokerage houses.

3.2.1 Nature of Investment

 An investment could be either fixed interest securities (debentures/ loan stocks) or


equities.

 The investment in fixed interest securities, attracts fixed interest, on the nominal value of
the investment, which may be payable annually, semi-annually or quarterly.

 The value of the investment is the (Quoted Price x Nominal Value) plus other cost (if
purchased) or less other cost (if sold)

 For the fixed interest securities, the investment can be purchased/ sold cum-div / interest
(including Dividend) or ex-div / Interest (excluding dividend).

Cum – div is a situation when the price includes the right of a buyer to receive the next
instalment of interest, including subsequent instalments of interest.

Ex-div is a situation when price does not include the right of a buyer to receive the next
instalment of interest. He is then entitled to subsequent instalments of interest. All prices are
“Cum-div” unless w hen specifically stated to be ex-div.

3.3 Accounting Entries

This topic will be discussed under the underlisted sub-topics.

3.3.1 Fixed Interest Securities

A. Purchases cum-div

(i) Compute net purchase price a:s (Quoted Price x Nominal Value) + Stamp duty, brokerage
etc. - Accrued Interest.

(ii) DR Investment A/c (capital column) with the purchase price DR Accrued Interest
Account (Income column) with Accrued interest. CR Bank A/c with Purchase Price; DR
Bank A/c and CR Investment A/c (Income Column)} with interest including the
immediate one.

B. Purchases ex-div

i) Compute purchase price as: (quoted price x nom. value) + stamp duty brokerage etc.
DR Investment A/c (capital column)} with purchase price.

77
ii) CR Bank A /c

iii) DR Investment A/c (capital column)} with interest CR Investment A/c (income
column)

iv) DR Bank A/c CR Investment A/c (income column) } with the instalments of interest
excluding the Immediate next one

C. Sales cum-div

(i) Calculate NET Proceeds as: (quoted price x nom. value) - (Brokerage, Stamp duty etc.
+ Accrued interest).

(ii) DR Bank A/c - with Net Proceeds, CR Investment A/c (Income Column) with
accrued interest; CR Investment A/c (Capital Column) with balance net proceeds.

(iii) Calculate Profit / Loss on Sales = Net Proceeds – Cost W here Cost = Nom. Value of
Inv. Sold x Average Cost Nom. Value of Total Investment and Average Cost =
Purchase Cum Div - Net Purchase Price; Purchase Ex Div = Purchase Price plus
interest.

(iv) DR P & L A/c} with loss on sale; CR Investment A/c (capital column); DR
Investment A/c (capital column)} with profit on sale; CR P & L A/c.

(v) DR Bank A/c; CR Investment A/c (income column) } with interest on Net
Investment, that is Purchases – Sales as from immediate next instalment sales ex-div.

D. Sales ex- div

(i) Calculate the net proceeds (as in sales cum- div)

(ii) Calculate the interest on the securities sold from the date of sales to the date of next
instalment

(iii) DR Bank A/c} CR Investment A/c (capital column)} with net proceeds

(iv) DR Investment A/c (income column; CR Investment A/c (capital column)} with
interest in step 2.

(v) Calculate Profit/Loss on disposal = Net Proceeds+ Interest – Cost:

Where Cost = Nom. Val. of Inv. Sold x Average Cost


Nom. Val. of Total Inv.

3.3.2 Equities

The current practice is not to make an apportionment of dividend on purchase or sales of


equities, either “cum” or ‘ex’ dividend. The full cost of investment including expenses is
debited to the capital column.

78
(a) DR Investment A/c (nominal column)} with cost of investment CR Bank A/c}
including expenses.

(b) DR Investment A/c (nominal column)} with Bonus Shares (Scrip Issue) CR Bank
A/c.

(c) DR Investment A/c (capital column)} with amount paid to CR Bank A/c purchase the
right taken-up.

(d) DR Bank A/c} with sales proceeds on the right sold Cr investment a/c(capital
column). No record will be made as regard the Nominal Value.

(e) DR Bank A/c}with dividend received CR Investment A/c (income column).

Note:

When two prices are quoted in a question e.g. 60k to 75k, the lower is the purchase price
whilst the higher is the sales price. For balance sheet purposes, the mid-market price is taken.

Illustration 7-1

The following transactions of Ayo investments ltd took place during the year ended June 30,
2008.

1/7/12 Purchased N120,000 4% Rivers State Development Stock (Interest Payable


February & August) at 60½ %

Purchased N 300,000 9% Treasury bill at 68 (Interest payable Oct & April


Brokerage and other expenses amounted to N 1,000.

12/7/2007 Purchased 200,000 ordinary shares each in NDC PLC for N 400,000

1/8/2007 Received half-year’s interest on 4% River State Dev. Stock

15/8/2007 NDC PLC made a bonus issue of 3 ordinary shares for every 2 held. 25,000
units of the bonus issue was sold for N 10 each

30/8/2007 Purchased N 150,000 9% Treasury bill at 70 ex – div

1/10/2007 Received interest on 9% Treasury bill – Purchased 50,000 Ordinary Shares of


N 1 each in OPC PLC at N 7.75 each

2/01/2008 Sold N 30,000 4% River State Dev. Stock at 61 ex- div

1/02/2008 Received half – year’s interest on 4% River State Dev stock

1/03/2008 Received Dividend of 18% on shares in NDC PLC.

1/04/2008 Received interest on 9% Treasury bill


OPC PLC made a right issue on the basis of ‘1 for 2’ at 5 / share. Half of the
right was sold on the market for N 2.50 per share.
79
01/06/2008 Received Dividend of 12 1/2% on shares in O PC Plc.

You are required to w rite up the relevant investment accounts as they would appear in the
books of Ayo Investments Limited for the year ended 30 June2008

Suggested Solution 7-1

INVESTMENT – 4% RIVER STATE DEVELOPMENT STOCK


Nom N Income Capital Nom N income N Capital N
N N
1/7/07 bank 120,000 2,000 70,600 1/8/07 2,400
purchase bank
2/1/08 adj. For 100 interest 30,000 18,300
ex-div 2/1/08
30/1/08investme 4,200 bank sales 100
nt income 2/1/08 adj.
30/1/08 p&l a/c 750 For ex-div
2/1/08 2,400
120,000 6,300 71,350 bank 90,000 1,500 52,950
interest 120,000 6,300 71,350
1/7/04 bal b/d 90,000 1,500 52,950 30/6/08
balc/d

NDC PLC – ordinary shares a/c


Nom N Income Capital Nom N income Capital
N N N N
12/8/07 bank 200,000 400,000 15/8/07 bank 250,000 250,000
purchase sales
15/8/07 bonus 300,000 1/3/08 bank 22,500
issue dividend
1/3/08 investment 22,500 30/6/08 bal c/d 250,000 200,000
income
31/6/08 profit on
disposal ______ ______ 50,000
500,000 22,500 450,000 ______ _____ _______
1/7/04 bal b/d 500,000 22,500 450,000
250,000 200,000

OPC PLC – Ordinary shares


Nom N Income Capital Nom N income Capital
N N N N
1/10/07 bank 50,000 387,500 1/4/08 bank
purchase sales of right 31,256
1/4/08 bank right 12,500 62,500 1/6/08 bank 7,812.50
30/6/08 dividend
investment 7,812.50 30/6/08 bal 62,500 418,750

80
income c/d
62,500 7812.50 450,000 _____ ______ _______
62,500 - 418,750 62,500 7812.50 450,000
1/7/08 bal b/d

Investment – 9% Treasury bill


Nom N Income Capital Nom N Income Capital
N N N N
1/7/07 bank 300,000 6,750 198,250 30/8/07 bank 1,125
purchase sales of right
30/8/07 purchase 150,000 105,000 1/10/07 bank 13,500
30/8/07 adj. For 1,125 interest
ex-div 1/4/08 bank 20,250
30/6/08investment 34,875 interest
income _____ _____ ______ 30/6/08 bal
450,000 41,625 304,375 c/d 450,000 6,750 304,375
1/7/48 bal b/d 450,000 6,750 304,375 450,000 41,625 304,375

Note: Securities in fixed interest (loan Stock), are normally quoted in units of N 100, unless
otherwise specified

Purchase Price of 4% Rivers State Dev Stock will be:

N 120,000* 0.605= N 72,600


Accrued interest=5/12*4%*120,000 (2,000)
70,600

3.4 Underwriter’s Account

3.4.1 Nature and terms of underwriting

An underwriter is one who undertakes to take over shares not purchased when they are being
offered for sale to the public or by private placement, in return for an agreed commission.

The following terminologies are relevant:

(a) Underwriting Commission – This is the commission an underwriter receives on the


value of shares he underwrites. This is based on the original contract, NOT on the
portion actually taken up.

(b) Sub-Underwriting Commission – This is the commission t he principal underwriter


will pay to a sub-underwriter in case he enters into a sub-underwriting agreement in
order to spread the risk. This is based on the original value of the contract and NOT
on the portion taken up.

(c) Overriding Commission – This is the additional commission paid to the principal
underwriter in case of sub-underwriting agreement.
81
(d) Firm Application – This is the number of shares, which will be allotted to the
principal underwriter in addition to the proportion to be underwritten, on the residue,
not fully subscribed by the public.

3.4.2 Book keeping procedure

 Open a separate account for each underwriting contract


 Provide separate columns for shares and cash

Accounting entries

(a) DR: Underwriting A/c} with application and allotment proceeds, CR: Cash / Bank A/c}
in respect of shares taken over.

N.B: If there is any excess payment on application due to the advance payment; the excess
will be set-off against allotment monies.

(b) DR: Bank / Cash A/c CR: Underwriting A/c} with Commission Received

(c) DR: Underwriting A/c} CR: Bank / Cash A/c } with Commission paid to sub-
underwriter.

Note: If shares are received for remuneration, DR the shares column only.

(d) DR: Underwriting A/c} CR: Bank / Cash A/c} with the option paid for.

(e) DR Bank / Cash A/c CR Underwriting A/c} with option money Received.

(f) DR: Underwriting A/c} with incidental expenses on CR: Bank / Cash A/c} underwriting
contract.

(g) DR: Underwriting A/c} CR: P & L A/c} with profit on underwriting contract.

(h) DR P & L A/c} Underwriting A/c} with loss on underwriting contract.

(i) DR Closing stock of} with value of closing stock of unsold shares} shares CR
Underwriting A /c}.

Illustration 7-2

Frontline Ltd decided to issue 1,000,000 shares of N 1.00 each at par, 10kobo payable on
application, 40kobo on allotment and 50kobo on first and final call. Yinkus Ltd, a finance
company, agrees to underwrite the whole issue, at a commission of 2.5% and to apply firm
for 200,000 shares. Yinkus Ltd arranged with Funky Ltd that they sub-underwrite 25% of the
shares for a commission of 2%.

The public applies for and was allotted 400,000 shares and Yinkus Ltd w as allotted the
firm’s application for 200,000 shares.

82
Yinkus Ltd had deposited cheque designed for the application money on shares underwritten
and Funky Ltd in turn, had deposited the relevant cheques and which cleared when the result
of the issue became known and commission due was paid.

After allotment and before final payment, Yinkus Ltd sold 100,000 shares at 45k each,
having made the final payment. Yinkus Ltd then sold 250,000 shares at 110k each.

At the end of the financial year of Yinkus Ltd, shares of Frontline Ltd were valued at 120k
each.

You are required to prepare the Underwriting Account of Yinkus Ltd reflecting the above
transactions.

Suggested Solution 7-2


YINKUS LTD
UNDERWRITING A/C
N Shares Shares N
Bank firm application 500,000 50,000 Bank 25,000
Bank-shares taken on 200,000 comm.rec’d 100,000 45,000
allot 200,000 Bank-sales 250,000 275,000
Bank-final call 5,000 Bank-sales 150,000 150,000
Bank-comm paid 40,000 Bal c/d
P&l a/c ______ _______ _______ ______
500,000 495,000 500,000 495,000
150,000 150,000

3.5 Stock Brokerage Account

3.5.1 Introduction

Only a Stockbroker who is a member of the Nigerian Stock Exchange is allowed to deal in
quoted stocks and shares on behalf of his clients, on the capital market’s trading floor.

A stockbroker buys or sells stocks and shares based on his client’s instruction at a price
determined daily on the floor of the Exchange by market forces. After buying or selling, the
stockbroker will send to his client a contract note detailing the unit price, quotation of shares
bought or sold, commissions and charges payable or receivable on the transactions.

3.5.2 Accounting Entries

On purchase of shares by a client:


Debit Credit With
A Client Jobber commission Price paid for shares
receivable stamp account stockbrokers
contract stamp account Commissions stamp duty on
purchase contract stamp
B Jobber bought Bought ticket accounts Make up price of shares plus
stamp account stamp duty
C Jobber or cash Cash or jobber Diff btw price paid for shares
and make up price(plus stamp
83
duty)
D Cash Client Cash received from client
E Ticket account Cash Cash paid to stock exchange
for purchases during the
account
F Contract sold account Cash Monthly payment to the inland
revenue
G Commission receivable Profit and loss account Commission earned

On sale of shares by a client


Debit Credit With
A Jobber account Client commission receivable Net proceeds selling
contract stamp Commission
contract stamp account
B Ticket account Jobber’s inland revenue Make up price of shares sold
Buyer’s stamp duty plus
C Jobber or cash Cash or jobber Diff btw gross proceed and
make up price
D Inland revenue Cash Stamp duty paid on behalf of
the buyer
E Contract stamp Cash Monthly payment to the inland
revenue
F Cash Ticket account Cash received from the stock
exchange for sales
G Client Cash Payment to client of net
proceeds
H Commission receivable a/c Profit and loss account Commission for accounting
period

In practice, a Contract Journal will be used for the entries of purchases and Sales

Illustration 7-3

Mr Johnson a stockbroker carried out the following instructions for his clients:

From Mr. Ayodele- purchased 2000 shares of Cadbury plc at N 72


From Mr. Ayodele- purchased 1000 shares of Unilever plc at N 80
From Mr. Adamu- sold 2000 shares of BOC gases plc at N 5
From Mr. Okoro- purchased 10,000 shares of Texaco plc at N 100
From Mr. Okoro- sold 5000 shares of Nigerian breweries at N 60

Stockbrokers commission is 1% and stamp duty of 1% is payable on every transaction.

Prepare contract journal of the stockbroker.

84
Suggested Solution
MR JOHNSON
CONTRACT JOURNAL
Date Name Des. Of Price Total Name Des. Of Stamp N
of party securities N value of securities duties
N party & comm
Ayodele 2000 72 146,880 Dealer 2,880 144,000
Cadbury
plc
Ayodele 1000 80 81,600 Dealer 1,600 80,000
Unilever
plc
Dealer 5 10,000 Adamu 2000BOC 200 9,800
200 Gases plc
Okoro 10000 100 1,020,000 Dealer 20,000 1,000,000
Texaco
plc
Dealer 60 300,000 Okoro 5000Nig 6,000 294,000
breweries
1,558,480 30,680 1,527,800
(1) (2) (3)

 Each item is debited to Dealer or Client Account


 Half credited to stamp duties account and half credited to commission a/c
 Each item credited to dealer or client A/c.

Self Assessment Questions

1. Details of Income and Expenditure of an Investment Trust Company is contained in its


________________

(a) Balance Sheet


(b) Income and Expenditure
(c) Revenue and Expenditure Account
(d) Profit and Loss Account
(e) Revenue Account

2._________ is the record maintained by a stockbroker where transactions entered into on


behalf of clients are recorded.

(a) Contract Journal


(b) Stock Ledger
(c) Transaction Journal
(d) Cash book
(e) Clients Ledger

4.0 CONCLUSION

Investment accounting is a very important aspect or part of accounting and as such, thorough
understanding of the theoretical aspect of it is indeed very beneficial.

85
5.0 SUMMARY

In this unit, details of the double entry principles and related books of accounts maintained by
the operators of investment, underwriting and stock broking firms were extensively discussed
and practical solutions were made to some examples.

In the next unit, we shall explore another topic ‘accounting for lease and hire purchase
transactions’.

6.0 TUTOR-MARKED ASSIGNMENT

1. State two functions of a Stockbroker.


2. Distinguish between investment purchased or sold Cum– Div and Ex – Div.
3. Define the concepts investment and investment account.

7.0 REFERENCES/FURTHER READINGS

Adapted from the ICAN Study Packs (2011)

86
UNIT TWO ACCOUNTING FOR LEASE AND HIRE PURCHASE

CONTENTS

1.0 Introduction
2.0 Objectives
3.0 Main Content
3.1 Lease Accounting
3.2 Hire Purchase
4.0 Conclusion
5.0 Summary
6.0 Tutor-Marked Assignment
7.0 References/Further Readings

1.0 INTRODUCTION

In the last unit, you were introduced to investment accounting. We also discussed the feature
of investment account, accounting entries in investment account, underwriter’s account and
stock brokerage’s account.

In this unit, we shall explore accounting for lease and hire purchase.

2.0 OBJECTIVES

At the end of this unit, you should be able to:

 Discuss the theoretical aspects of lease accounting;


 Apply the various methods of accounting to finance charges in the books of lessor and
lessee;
 Understand the accounting for hire purchase transactions.

3.0 MAIN CONTENT

3.1 Lease Accounting

Statement of Accounting Standards (SAS) No.11 stipulates detailed appropriate treatment


and disclosure of lease transactions in the books of both the lessor and lessee.

A lease is a contractual agreement between an owner, the lessor, and another party, the
lessee, which conveys to the latter, the right to use the leased asset for an agreed period of
time in return for a consideration, usually periodic payments called ‘rents’. Leasing
arrangements are usually contracted as operating lease or finance / capital lease.

Operating lease is one in which the lessor, while giving the lessee the use of the leased
property, retains practically all the risks, obligations and rewards of ownership (for example;
early obsolescence and appreciation).

Finance or capital lease is one in which ownership risks, rewards are transferred to the lessee,
who is under obligation to pay such costs as insurance, maintenance and similar charges on
the property. Usually, the agreement is non cancellable and the lessee has the option to buy
the property for a nominal amount upon the expiration of the lease.
87
Other forms of Finance or Capital leases are:

(a) Leveraged Lease is three-party lease involving a lender (often a financial institution) in
addition to the usual lessor and lessee. The lender supplies, in most cases, the greater part
of the purchase price of the leased asset.

(b) Sales – Typed Lease is one where the offeror or dealer (the Lessor) transfers substantially
all the ownership risks and benefits of the property to the lessee and at the inception of
the lease, the fair value of the leased property is greater or less than its carrying amount in
the books of the lessor, resulting in a profit or loss to the lessor, w ho is often a
manufacturer or dealer.

(c) Direct Finance Lease is one which transfers substantially all the ownership risks and
benefits of the property to the lessee and at the inception of the lease, the fair value of the
leased asset is the same as its carrying amount to the lessor (often not the manufacturer or
dealer).

(d) ‘Sales and Lease Back’ is one in which the seller of the property leases it back from the
buyer.

3.1.1 Accounting for Leases in the Books of the Lessee

The following steps are necessary:

Step 1: Calculate the total lease payments, that is:

Installmental payment x No of Instalments

Step 2: Compute cash /fair value of the leased property.

It may be given, but if not, calculate it as follows:

(a) Installments in arrears (that is, at year end)

= instalment (1-(1+r)n)
r

Where r = lease rental rate


n = duration of the lease.

(b) Installments in advance (that is, at the beginning of the year):

Instalment 1 – (1+ r)t + 1


r

Where t = n-1
n = duration of the lease

Step 3: Compute the depreciation on the cash price/ fair value of the leased asset.

Step 4: Calculate the total interest on the lease / finance charges:


88
Total lease payment xx
Cash / fair value (x)
Total lease interest / finance charges x

3.1.2 Treatment of Finance Charges

Finance charges may be spread over the period of the lease, using:

(a) Straight line method;


(b) Sum of the years digit method; and
(c) Actuarial method

Straight Line Method

Finance charges are distributed evenly over the period of the lease and are written off to
Profit and Loss Account accordingly, that is: Finance charge
Duration of lease

Sum of the Years Digit Method

The financial charges will be written off to profit and loss account on the basis of the sum of
the years’ digits. For a leased asset with 3years life span, the finance charges will be
distributed into each year’s profit and loss account as follows:

Year digit proportion


1 3 3/6
2 2 2/6
3 1 1/6
6

Actuarial Method

Interest in each period will be computed on the balance after deducting the Installmental
payments and adding the interest due on the cash price.

3.1.3 Accounting Records

Interest payable method interest suspense method


a) Leased assets a/c leased assets a/c
b) Prov. for depreciation a/c prov. For depreciation a/c
c) Lessors a/c lessors a/c
d) Finance charges a/c finance charges a/c
e) Profit and loss account p&l a/c
Finance charges suspense a/c

3.1.4 Accounting Entries

Interest Payable Method

1. DR leased assets account


CR lessor’s account
89
With cash price/fair value of leased assets

2. DR finance charge a/c


CR lessor’s a/c
With interest for each of the period

3. DR lessor’s a/c
CR bank a/c
With the Installmental payment

4. DR P&L a/c
CR finance charge a/c
With the interest due for each period

5. DR P&L a/c
CR prov. For depr a/c
With the depreciation for each period

Interest Suspense Method

1. DR leased assets a/c


CR lessor’s a/c
With cash price/fair value of the leased assets

2. DR interest suspense a/c


CR lessor’s a/c
With the total lease interest

3. DR finance charge a/c


CR interest suspense a/c
With the interest due for each of the period

4. DR P&L a/c
CR finance charge a/c
With the interest due for each of the period

5. DR lessor’s a/c
CR bank a/c
With Installmental payment

6. DR P&L a/c
CR prov. For depr a/c
With depr for each period

Illustration 8-1

Bakasi Haulage Contractors Limited has two alternatives. It could either buy or lease a new
truck at a cost of N18million. The terms of the lease are as follows:

(a) The primary period of the lease is for 4 years from January 1 2008, with a rental
repayment of N 6million per annum, payable on December 31 of each year
90
(b) The lessee has the right to continue t o lease the truck after the end of primary period for
an indefinite period, subject to only a nominal rent

(c) The lessee is required to pay for repairs, maintenance and insurance cost as they arise

(d) The interest rate implicit in the lease is 15% per annum.

(e) The lessee estimated that the useful economic life of the truck is 6 years and that
depreciation could be calculated on straight line basis.

Required:
a) Compute the finance charge to be recognised on the leased truck under the different
methods of spreading finance charges

b) Record detailed accounting entries in respect of one of the methods identified in (a) above

Suggested Solution 8-1

BAKASI HAULAGE CONTRACTORS LIMITED

(a) Calculation of finance charge

(i)Total lease payment: 6million *4 = 24million


(ii) The fair value of the leased truck:
Instalment) 1-(1+r)n) = N6m*(1-(1.15)-4
R 0.15
(Installmental payment in arrears) = N 6m *2.8550
= N 17,130,000
(iii) Depreciation: N 17,130,000
6yrs = N 2,8550,000
(iv) Calculation of interest:

Total instalments - 24,000,000


Cash price/fair value (17,130,000)
Total interest/finance charge N 6,870,000

Straight line method: total interest = N 6,870,000

Lease period 4
= N 1,717,500

Sum of the years digit method


Year Digit Interest allocation Finance charge
N’000
1 4 4/10*6,870,000 2,748
2 3 3/10*6,870,000 2,061
3 2 2/10*6,870,000 1,374
4 1 1/10*6,870,000 687
10 6,870

91
Actuarial method
Interest
N’000 N’000
Fair value/cash price 17,130
Add: interest – 15%*17,130,000 2,570 2,570
19,700
Less 1st instalment 6,000
13,700
Add: interest – 15% of 13,700,000 2,055 2,055
15,755
Less 2nd instalment 6,000
9,755
Add: interest- 15% of 9,755,000 1,463 1,463
11,218
Less 3rd instalment 6,000
5,218
Add: interest – 15% of 5,218,000 782 782
6,000
Less 4th instalment 6,000
NIL 6,870

(b) Accounting entries


Under interest payable method
Leased truck account
N’000 N’000
1/1/05 lessor a/c 17,130 31/12/05 Bal c/d 17,130
1/1/06 bal b/d 17,130 31/12/06 Bal c/d 17,130
1/1/07 bal b/d 17,130 31/12/07 Bal c/d 17,130
1/1/08 bal b/d 17,130 31/12/08 Bal c/d 17,130

Provision for depreciation account


N’000 N’000
31/12/06 bal c/d 2,855 31/12/06 P&L a/c 2,855
31/12/07 bal c/d 5,710 1/1/07 bal b/d 2,855
____ 31/12/07 P&L a/c 2,855
5,710 5,710
31/12/08 bal c/d 8,565 1/1/08 bal b/d 5,710
____ 31/12/08 P&L a/c 2,855
8,565 8,565
1/1/09 bal b/d 8,565

Lessor’s account
N’000 N’000
31/12/05 instalment 6,000 1/1/05 leased truck a/c 17,130
31/12/05 bal c/d 13,700 31/12/05 finance charges 2,570
19,700

31/12/06 instalment 6,000 1/1/06 Bal b/d 13,700


31/12/06 bal c/d 9,755 31/12/06 finance charges 2,055
92
15,755 15,755

31/12/07 instalment 6,000 1/1/07 Bal b/d 9,755


31/12/07 bal c/d 5,218 31/12/07finance charges 1,463
11,218 11,218
31/12/08 instalment 6,000 1/1/08 Bal b/d 5,218
____ 31/12/08 finance charges 782
6,000 6,000

Finance charges account


N’000 N’000
31/12/05 lessor a/c 2,570 31/12/05p&l a/c 2,570
31/12/06 lessor a/c 2,055 31/12/06 p&l a/c 2,055
31/12/07 lessor a/c 1,463 31/12/07 p&l a/c 1,463
31/12/08 lessor a/c 782 31/12/08 p&l a/c 782

Under Interest Suspense Account Method

Finance charges/leased truck & depreciation provision accounts are the same as under interest
payable a/c method.
Finance charges suspense account
N’000 N’000
31/12/05 lessor a/c 6,870 31/12/05finance charges 2,570
____ 31/12/05 bal c/d 4,300
6870 6,870
31/12/06 bal b/d 4,300 31/12/06 finance charges 2,055
_____ 31/12/06bal c/d 2,245
4,300 4,300
31/12/07 bal b/d 2,245 31/12/07 finance charges 1,463
_____ 31/12/07 bal c/d 782
2,245 2,245
31/12/08 bal b/d 782 31/12/08 finance charges 782

Lessor’s account
N’000 N’000
31/12/05 bank 6,000 1/1/05 leased truck 17,130
31/12/05 bal c/d 18,000 31/12/05 finance charges 6,870
24,000 24,000
31/12/06 bank 6,000 1/1/06 bal b/d 18,000
31/12/06 bal c/d 12,000 ______
18,000 18,000
31/12/07 bank 6,000 1/1/07 bal b/d 12,000
31/12/07 bal c/d 6,000 _____
12,000 12,000
31/12/08 6,000 1/1/08 bal b/d 6,000

93
3.2 Hire Purchase

A hire purchase transaction is one in which the seller of an item parts with possession and
transfers same to a buyer who in return, pays to the seller an amount known as hire purchase
price by way of an initial deposit plus periodic instalments over the hire purchase period. The
hire purchase price will normally be higher than the normal selling price of the item; the
difference being hires purchase interest or finance charge.

It should be noted that what the hire purchaser has, while the hire period lasts, is just
possession. H e does not acquire the title until he has paid the last instalment and exercised
his option to acquire title by paying a further token sum, which shall be stipulated in the hire
purchase agreement.

The hire purchaser, however, has the first option and the item cannot be sold to another
person unless he has indicated his unwillingness to exercise the option.

3.2.1 Definition of Hire Purchase Terminologies

Hire purchase price: This is the total sum (deposit plus instalments) payable by the hire
purchaser.

Cash price: This is the normal selling price of the goods to be sold

Hire purchase interest: or finance charge, is the excess of the hire purchase price over the
cash price. The hire purchaser interest is the compensation to the seller for having his funds
tied down with the buyer over the hire period

Deposit: This is the initial sum payable by the hire purchaser at the inception of the hire
purchase transaction

Instalment: this is the sum payable by the hire purchaser buyer at specified intervals to
liquidate the balance of the hire purchase price at the end of the hire period.

3.2.2 Accounting for Hire Purchase Transactions in Buyer’s Books

It is in the nature of hire purchase transactions that w hat the buyer buys under this
arrangement is invariably a fixed asset. To acquire trading stocks under a hire purchase
arrangement is virtually not feasible for the following reasons:

(a) The hire purchase option is normally chosen where the value of the item is relatively high
and payment under cash purchase transactions will involve much cash outflow. It is
unlikely that trading stocks will fall under this category

(b) Goods purchased under hire purchase terms cannot be sold during the hire period

(c) To acquire trading stocks under hire purchase terms w ill require so short a hire period as
to nullify the benefits of the hire purchase arrangement

The hire purchaser shall bring the asset on hire purchase into his books as a fixed asset and
depreciate it normally, even though; he has not yet acquired title. This is an instance where

94
the financial reality or substance of a transaction takes precedence over the legal form in
compliance with the convention of “substance over form.

3.2.3 The Hire Purchase Interest/Finance Charge

The hire purchaser spreads the hire purchase interest on a rotational basis over the hire
period. This may be achieved by using any of the following methods:

(a) Equal instalments (or straight line) method


(b) Sum of the years digit method
(c) Actuarial method

(a) Equal instalments (or straight line method)

The hire purchase interest is spread equally over the hire period. It is the simplest method.

Illustration 8-2

ABC sold a machine to XYZ on hire purchase basis. You are given the following
information.

Cash price N 28,000


Initial deposit N 10,000

A yearly instalment of N 7,500 each payable on 31december for 4years, was agreed. The
company makes up accounts to 31 December.

Required: calculate the hire purchase interest attributable to each year

Suggested Solution 8-2


N
Initial deposit 10,000
Add: instalments (N 7,500 *4) 30,000
Hire purchase price 40,000
Less cash price (28,000)
Hire purchase interest 12,000

Therefore, hire purchase interest written off each year is N 12,000


4 = N 3,000

(b) Sum of the Years Digits Method

Under this method, H .P. interest is written off over the hire period in a reducing manner,
based on digits as illustrated below:

Assuming the facts are the same as in illustration (a) above,


Calculate the H ire purchase interest attributable to each Year
Year Digit allocated Workings H.P interest
N
1 4 4/10* N 12,000 4,800
2 3 3/10* N 12,000 3,600
95
3 2 2/10* N 12,000 2,400
4 1 1/10* N 12,000 1,200
12,000

In a situation where the number of instalments is high, the determination of the sum of the
digits becomes a problem. To solve the problem, you can use the formula below:

S = n/2 (n-1)

Where: s= sum of the digits


n= no of instalments

In the above example, sum of the digits = 4/ 2(4-1)


=10

(c) Actuarial Method

Under this method, H .P. interest is written off by charging a fixed rate of interest on the
outstanding balance at the date of instalments. This method produces a constant periodic rate
of return on the outstanding cash price for each period. The rate of interest may be obtained
from actuarial table. Alternatively, the rate may be calculated using the annuity formula and
solving for r, the interest rate. The annuity formula is given as follows:

p= a(1-(1+r)n1

Where p = cash price less deposit

a= instalment payable at specified intervals


n = number of instalments
r= rate of interest per period covered by each instalment

Illustration 8-3

John sold equipment to Janet on hire purchase. You are given the following information:
N
Cash price 20,945
Initial deposit 8,000

The HP contract agreed annual instalments of N 5,000 each, payable on 31 December over
4years period. HP interest is charged at 20% per annum.

Required: compute interest payable using the actuarial method.

Suggested Solution 8-3


HIRE PURCHASE INTEREST
N N
Year 0 cash price 20,945
Less deposit 8,000
12,945
96
Year 1 HP interest at 20% 2,589 2,589
15,534
1st instalment (5,000)
10,534
Year 2 HP interest at 20 % 2,106 2,106
12,640
2nd instalment (5,000)
7,640
Year 3 HP interest @ 20% 1,528 1,528
9,168
3rd instalment (5,000)
4,168
Year 4 HP Interest at 20 % 832 832
5,000
4th instalment (5,000)
NIL 7,055

Self Assessment Exercise

Periodic payments made by the lessee to the lessor are called:

a) Rent
b) Interest
c) Cash price
d) Finance charge
e) Lease payment

4.0 CONCLUSION

Leasing and hire are like terms and as such, there is the identical problem of computing and
charging to respective periods, finance charges and hire purchase interest for leasing and hire
purchase respectively.

5.0 SUMMARY

This unit discussed the various methods of determining finance charges and hire purchase
interest in the books of the lessor. SAS 11 stipulates detailed appropriate treatment and
disclosures of lease transactions in the books of the lessor and lessee.

In the next unit, we shall examine the topic: accounting for specialised businesses.

6.0 TUTOR-MARKED ASSIGNMENT

Use the following information to answer the two questions below:

Demola sold a new motorcycle to Bola, an Okada Operator, on hire purchase basis under the
following terms:

Cash price N280,000


Initial deposit N 110,000

97
Yearly Instalment N 75,000 (payable 31 December)
Hire period 4years.

1. Calculate the hire purchase price of the motorcycle


2. Compute the hire purchase interest to be written off each year using straight line method.
3. Write short notes on the underlisted terms:
 Rent
 Interest
 Cash price
 Finance charge
 Lease payment

7.0 REFERENCES/FURTHER READINGS

Adapted from the ICAN Study Packs (2011)

98
UNIT THREE ACCOUNTING FOR SPECIALISED BUSINESSES

CONTENTS

1.0 Introduction
2.0 Objectives
3.0 Main Content
3.1 Voyage / Shipping Accounts
3.2 Account of Cooperative Societies
4.0 Conclusion
5.0 Summary
6.0 Tutor-Marked Assignment
7.0 References/Further Readings

1.0 INTRODUCTION

In the last unit, we discussed the various methods of determining finance charges and hire
purchase interest in the books of the lessor. SAS 11 stipulates detailed appropriate treatment
and disclosures of lease transactions in the books of the lessor and lessee.

In this unit, we shall examine the topic: accounting for specialised businesses, particularly
voyage/shipping accounts as well as the account of cooperative societies.

2.0 OBJECTIVES

At the end of this unit, you should be able to prepare the accounts of shipping companies and
corporative societies.

3.0 MAIN CONTENT

3.1 Voyage/Shipping Accounts

Shipping companies are expected to maintain a separate voyage account for each vessel to
ascertain profit / loss from each voyage. It is like a profit and loss account of a trading
concern. All expenses relating to a voyage (for example, stores, w ages, insurance,
commission brokerage, fuel and repairs) are debited to the voyage account. All earnings,
passage money, freight and mail money (if any) are credited to voyage account. The balance
on the voyage account represents the profit or loss made on the voyage and is transferred to
the general profit and loss account.

Illustration 9-1

SS Olokun was chartered on 1 March 2008, by Ocean View Shipping Agency Ltd from
Awaye Lines Limited. It sets on a voyage on that date as follows:

Accra to Apapa with general cargo at N 2,300 per ton. The charter stipulates for an address
commission to the chatterers of 2% on freight, payable on signing the bill of lading together
with a brokerage of 5% to the charters’ agents, of which, one fifth is repayable to the vessel.
Conakry to Port Harcourt is at N 1,700 per ton. Address commission of 2% on freight
payable to chatterers and brokerage of one-third of 5% payable to charters agents on signing
charter. The vessel w as insured by Cornerstone Insurance PLC on 1 January 2008, for one
99
year at N 3 million and managing owners’ Articles of Association fixed remuneration at 1.5%
of gross freight charges.

The following are relevant extracts from the shipping company’s account:

Freight of 15,000 tons of rice to apapa and 17,500 tons of rubber to Port Harcourt:
N
Wages for the year 9,600,000
Wharfage at Port Harcourt 1,750,000
Captains disbursement- port Harcourt 325,000
Wharfage at apapa 320,000
Agents’ disbursements- apapa 75,000
Captain’s disbursements –apapa 150,000
Stores accounts 560,000
Port charges etc. Accra 1,350,000
Captain’s accounts for labour wages 750,000
Fuel 711,000
Stevedores at Conakry 420,000
Provisions at Conakry 164,000
Repair on voyage 125,000
Captain’s expenses- Conakry 100,000
Agents’ accounts for port charges exclusive of 175,000
Address Commission and brokerage

Suggested Solution 9-1

OCEAN VIEW SHIPPING AGENCY LTD


VOYAGE ACCOUNT FOR THE PERIOD 1/3/04 to 30/11/04
N N
Outward-Accra to apapa(15000*2300) 34,500,000
Inward –conakry to port Harcourt(17,500*1,700) 29,750,000
64,250,000
Stores 560,000
Port charges 1,350,000
Captain accounts 750,000
Fuel 711,000
Stevedores 420,000
Provisions to Conakry 164,000
Repairs 125,000
Captains expenses –Conakry 100,000
Agents accounts 175,000
Wages (9/12* N 9600,000) 7,200,000
Wharfage-port Harcourt 1,750,000
Captains – port Harcourt 325,000
Wharfage –apapa 320,000
Agents etc 75,000
Insurance (9/12* N 3,000,000) 2,250,000
Captains- apapa 150,000
Outward-brokerage 5%* N 34,500,000* 4/5 1,380,000
Commission 2% * N 34,500,000 690,000
100
Inward –brokerage 5% * N 29,750,000 * 1/3 495,833
Commission 2% * N 29,750,000 595,000
Managing owner 1.5% * N 64,250,000 963,750
(20,549,583)
Profit on the voyage 43,700,417

3.2 Definition of a Cooperative Society

The International Labour Organisation defines cooperative society as follows:

“An association of persons who have voluntarily joined together to


achieve a common end through the formation of democratically-
controlled organisation, making equitable contribution to the
capital required and accepting a fair share of the risk and benefits
of the undertaking in which the members actively participate” (Ige, 2009)

The United Nations Research on Social Development states that cooperative societies are all
organisations “legally recognized as such which is subject or organised supervision and
which claim to follow cooperative principles”.

The Cooperative Societies Decree 1993 defines cooperative society to mean “a voluntary
association of individuals, united by common bond, who have come together to pursue their
economic goals for their own benefit”. No matter the definition adopted, one thing that is
clear is that cooperative society is a voluntary association based on democratic norms and
controlled collectively by the members. There must be the will to cooperate.

3.2.1 Accounts of Co-operative Societies

Groups of individuals in employment, trade, commerce or industry come together to form a


co-operative society with a view to investing their resources for the benefits of the members.

The society is guided by its constitution and by-laws and must be registered with the Director
of Co-operative Societies of the State of its operations.

The Funds of a cooperative society are usually generated from the contributions from
members through direct monthly contributions and agreed deductions from members’
salaries, in case of employees. The fund is then lent to its members for a stated purpose at an
interest rate that is usually below the market rate.

Contributions from members could be in form of subscriptions to the society’s share capital,
members’ savings or education fund.

The society’s funds are invested in shares of limited liability companies, short-term deposits,
or commodities for sale to its members, to generate income for the society.

The officers of the society are obliged to prepare and lay before its members, the audited
financial statements of the society at a properly convened Annual General Meeting at which
issues relating to the activities of the society in the year under review and dividends payable
to members are discussed.

101
The accounts prepared by the society must include a Balance Sheet and a Revenue account
with relevant notes on the accounts.

Illustration 9-2

ONITSHA CO-OPERATIVE THRIFT AND CREDIT SOCIETY LIMITED


TRIALBALANCE AS AT 31DECEMBER 2008 IS AS FOLLOWS:
DR CR
N N
Fixed assets (net of depreciation) 196,770
Stocks of recharge card 168,045
Investments- short term deposits 4,382,510
-quoted 721,145
Members indebtedness: loans 19,018,339
Others 1,618,326
Bank and cash balances 601,962
Accrued expenses 403,500
Share capital 657,559
Share premium 101,524
Members’ savings 23,045,316
Reserve fund 1,087,710
Education fund 184,182
Interest income:
On members’ loans 1,448,402
On investment 817,719
Profit on sale of commodities 463,930
Entrance fees 3,000
Loan forms and processing fees 51,000
Sundry income 1,013
Staff salaries and expenses 259,610
Transport expenses 35,975
Telephone expenses 3,320
Committee meeting expenses 79,900
Printing and stationery 39,425
Bank charges and commission 232,625
General repairs and maintenance 31,290
Audit fees 20,000
Executive committee honoraria 103,500
AGM Expenses 280,000
Depreciation charge 6,583
Transfer to reserve fund 423,209
Transfer to education fund 42,321
28,264,855 28,264,855

After appropriation to reserve and education fund, the executive committee proposed to pay
N 1,227,000 as dividends to members and transfer the balance to general reserve.

Required: prepare the society’s reserve account for the year ended 31december 2008 and a
balance sheet as at that date.

102
Suggested Solution 9-2

ONITSHA CO-OPERATIVE THRIFT AND CREDIT SOCIETY LIMITED


REVENUE ACCOUNT FOR THE YEAR ENDED 31 DECEMBER 2008

INCOME
N N
Interest on members’ loans 1,448,402
Investment income 817,719
Profit on sale of commodities 463,930
Entrance fees 3,000
Loans forms and processing fees 51,000
Sundry income 1,013
Total income 2,785,064

CHARGES
Staff salaries and expenses 259,610
Transport expenses 35,975
Telephone 3,320
Committee meeting expenses 79,900
Printing and stationery 39,425
Bank charges and commissions 232,625
General repairs and maintenance 31,290
Audit fees 20,000
Executive committee honoraria 103,500
AGM expenses 280,000
Depreciation 6,583
TOTAL CHARGES (1,092,228)
SURPLUS FOR THE YEAR 1,692,836

APPROPRIATIONS:
Transfer to reserve fund 423,209
Transfer to education fund 42,321
Proposed dividend 1,277,000
1,692,530
Balance transferred to general reserve 306

ONITSHA CO-OPERATIVE THRIFT ADN CREDIT SOCIETY LIMITED


BALANCE SHEET AS AT 31 DECEMBER 2008
N N
ASSETS
Fixed assets 196,770
Investments- short term deposits 4,382,510
Quoted shares 721,145 5,103,655
Stocks of recharge cards 168,045
Members indebtedness- on loans 19,018,339
Others 1,618,326 20,636,665
Bank and cash balances 601,962
TOTAL ASSETS 26,707,097

103
LIABILITIES AND FUNDS
Current liabilities:
Accrued expenses 403,500
Proposed dividend 1,227,000

Members’ funds:
Share capital 657,559
Share premium 101,524
Members savings 23,045,316
Reserves fund 1,087,710
Education fund 184,710
General reserve 306
TOTAL FUNDS 25,076,597
TOTAL LIABILITIES AND FUNDS 26,707,097

Self Assessment Exercises

1. Which of the following expenses is not peculiar to shipping companies?


(a) Stevedores
(b) Salaries
(c) Port charges
(d) Captain expenses
(e) Wharfage

2. Co-operative Societies’ Funds are expected to be invested in the following except______


(a) Quoted Shares
(b) Treasury bills
(c) Commodities for sale to its members.
(d) Short–Term Deposits
(e) Plant and Machinery

3. State ONE guiding principle of a Co-operative Society.

4.0 CONCLUSION

This unit deals with the peculiarities associated with accounting for shipping businesses and
co-operative societies.

5.0 SUMMARY

This has shown that the rules of accounting are different when it applies to the above named
businesses and therefore, special consideration has to be paid to them.

In the next unit, we shall dwell extensively on the generally accepted accounting principles
(GAAP).

6.0 TUTOR-MARKED ASSIGNMENT

1. What do you mean by a Cooperative Society?


2. How is cooperative society fund generated?

104
7.0 REFERENCES/FURTHER READINGS

Adapted from the ICAN Study Packs (2011)

Ige, Ayodeji (2009). Cooperative Law. NOUN Course Materials for Undergraduate Students
in Cooperative Management.

105
UNIT FOUR GENERALLY ACCEPTED ACCOUNTING PRINCIPLES
(GAAP)

CONTENTS

1.0 Introduction
2.0 Objectives
3.0 Main Content
3.1 Meaning of GAAP
3.2 Purpose of GAAP
3.3 Sources of GAAP in Nigeria
3.4 International GAAP
3.5 Factors that Determine the Acceptability of an Accounting Practice
3.6 Accounting Concepts
3.7 Accounting Methods
3.8 Accounting Policies
3.9 Disclosure of Accounting Policies
4.0 Conclusion
5.0 Summary
6.0 Tutor-Marked Assignment
7.0 References/Further Readings

1.0 INTRODUCTION

In the last unit, we discussed the rules of accounting are different as it applies to the
voyage/shipping and cooperative society businesses.

In this unit, we shall dwell on the generally accepted accounting principles (GAAP).

2.0 OBJECTIVES

At the end of this unit, you should be able to:

 Understand the meaning and purpose of GAAP;


 Discuss the sources of GAAP in Nigeria;
 Know what constitutes international GGAAP;
 Explain the basic accounting principles and concepts in Nigerian GAAP.

3.0 MAIN CONTENT

3.1 Generally Accepted Accounting Principles (GAAP) – Meaning of GAAP

There are many alternative postulates, assumptions, principles and methods that could be
used in preparing the financial statements of a reporting entity. These alternative methods
impact on the financial position and operational results of corporate entities differently. To
ensure a degree of comparison of financial reports, there should be minimum uniform
standards and guidelines of financial accounting that different entities have to follow in
financial reporting. These standards are referred to as Generally Accepted Accounting
Principles (GAAP).

106
Stated simply, GAAP are the conventions, rules, procedures and broad guidelines adopted in
the preparation and presentation of financial statements in a given jurisdiction, e.g. Nigeria.
GAAP include broad ideas of measurement and classifications, as well as detailed rules and
procedures used by accountants in preparing and presenting accounting reports. The rules
followed by accountants in the preparation of financial statements are contained in the
accounting standards issued by the standard-setting body in a given jurisdiction. In Nigeria,
such standards are issued by the Nigerian Accounting Standards Board (NASB).

3.2 Purpose of GAAP

Adherence to generally accepted accounting principles serves five important purposes. These
are:

(a) It increases the ability of users of financial statements to understand the accounting
reports issued by different reporting entities

(b) It provides reasonable degree of comparison between financial reports presented by


entities since they adopt a standard framework of guidelines.

(c) It increases the confidence of investors, markets, and indeed the general public, that the
financial statements issued by a reporting entity, faithfully represents its transactions

(d) Preparers of financial statements have a set of guidelines which can be readily referred to
in accounting and reporting their financial transactions

(e) External auditors need GAAP to guide them in reporting on the truth and fairness or
otherwise of the financial transactions of different entities

3.3 Sources of GAAP in Nigeria

The sources of GAAP in Nigeria include:

(a) Companies and Allied Matters Act, CA P 20, LFN 2004;

(b) Insurance Act, 2003;

(c) Banks and other Financial Institutions Act 1991;

(d) National Insurance Commission Act 2003;

(e) Prudential guidelines issued by the Central Bank of Nigeria;

(f) Security and Exchange Commission and Stock Exchange rules and regulations;

(g) Accounting Standards issued by the Nigerian Accounting Standards Board (NASB);

(h) Accounting Standards issued by the International Accounting Standards Board


constitute a secondary source of GAAP in Nigeria;

(i) Pension Reforms Act, 2004.

107
3.4 International GAAP

In the previous sections of this chapter, we have interpreted GAAP as generally accepted
accounting principles. GAAP could also be interpreted as generally accepted accounting
practice. Some authors have argued that the term “principle” gives GAAP an unjustified
measure of permanence since the concept changes in response to new developments in the
business and economic environment.

The word “practice” perhaps better reflects the fact that accounting practice alters in response
to changes in different social-economic environments. GAA P, therefore, goes beyond mere
principles as they encompass contemporary accounting practices that are permissible within
an accounting environment.

By extension, International GAAP encompasses contemporary accounting practices that are


“regarded as permissible by the accounting profession and regulators internationally”
(Bonham, et al 2008).

The Accounting Standards issued by the International Accounting Standards Board (IASB)
constitute the source of international GAAP.

3.5 Factors that Determine the Acceptability of an Accounting Practice

The following factors, outlined by Bonham et al (2008), members of Ernst &Young Global,
provide useful guide in determining whether an accounting practice should be acceptable in a
country’s GAAP, as w ell as international GAAP.

(a) Is the practice addressed in accounting standards or other official pronouncements?

(b) Is the practice addressed in accounting standards that deal with similar and related issues?

(c) If the practice is not addressed in accounting standards, is it dealt with in the standards of
another country that could reasonably be considered to offer authoritative guidance?

(d) Is the practice consistent with the needs of users and the objectives of financial reporting?

(e) Does the practice have authoritative support in the accounting literature?

(f) Is the practice consistent with the underlying conceptual framework document?

(g) Does the practice meet basic criteria as to the quality of information required for financial
statements to be useful to users

(h) Does the practice fairly reflect the economic substance of the transaction involved?

(i) Is the practice consistent with the fundamental concept of ‘fair presentation’?

(j) Are other companies in similar situation generally applying the practice?

108
3.6 Accounting Concepts

These are generally accepted principles used in the preparation of financial statements and
are rarely disclosed because of their general acceptability. They are:

(a) Entity Concept: This principle assumes that a company or corporation is a separate
entity on its own; it can sue and be sued in a court of law
(b) Going Concern: The concept assumes that an organization will continue to operate for
the foreseeable future. The balance sheet and profit and loss account assume no
intention to liquidate or curtail its scale of operations
(c) Realization Concept: This concept recognizes revenue as soon as it is capable of
objective measurement and the value of asset is reasonably certain.
(d) Matching Concept: Under this concept, revenue or income and costs in a period are
matched and dealt with in the profit and loss account of the period they relate
(e) Double Entity Principle/Concept: This concept assumes that every transaction should
have two entries. In other words, where there is a debit entry, there has to be a
corresponding credit entry for proper accountability
(f) Consistency Concept: This means that every like item within each accounting period
should be treated the same way. This allows for easy comparison of accounts of an
entity over a period of time
(g) Prudence Concept: This assumes that income is actually realized, not estimated. That
is, revenue and profit should not be anticipated but recognized only when realized in
cash or other assets.

The methods adopted and applied by an organization in applying the


Prudence and realization concepts are basic concepts in determining profit made.
(h) Periodicity: This concept assumes that transactions should be separated into
particular periods for easy matching of revenue with expenses
(i) historical Cost: This assumes that items should be stated at their original cost of
purchase rather than realisable value

3.7 Accounting Methods

This is the medium through which accounting concepts are applied to financial transactions
in the preparation of financial statements.

The methods adopted and applied by an organization in applying the fundamental accounting
principles to its financial transactions are called the accounting bases.

There are two bases used in the preparation of financial statements. They are:

(a) The accrual basis; and


(b) The cash basis

3.8 Accounting Policy

Every organization or Corporation has a policy used in the preparation of its Accounts.
Accounting policies are therefore, the basic rules, principles, conventions and procedures
adopted in the preparation and presentation of financial statements.

109
3.9 Disclosure of Accounting Policies

Accounting policies adopted by an organization or Corporation in the preparation and


presentation of financial statements are disclosed under one heading to provide an overview

3.9.1 Use of Accounting Policies

Policies adopted by an organization are based on personal judgement and the suitability of
presenting a true and fair view of the result of an organization. Therefore, there is a need for
management to be careful and rational in their choice of accounting policies.

There are principles that should be used as a guide. These are:

(a) Substance over form: This principle states that generally the legal form of every
transaction is a basis for recording its commercial status in the books of accounts, but
there are instances whereby the legal status differs from the commercial status. In
such instances, the commercial status shall be recognized rather than the legal form.
For example, in a finance lease agreement, the commercial status is recognized by
including the assets acquired as part of the fixed assets of the lessee, despite the fact
that legal title remains with the lessor.

(b) Objectivity: This principle states that an accountant should be fair and unbiased in the
process of recording, collating, summarizing, analysing and interpreting financial
transactions. This implies that accountants should be fair to all users of financial
information and also treat transactions without emotion.

(c) Materiality: The principle holds that only items of material values are accorded strict
accounting treatment; that is, items with significant values.

(d) Prudence: Revenue and profits are not to be anticipated but recognized only when
realized while known losses should be adequately provided for.

(e) Fairness: This is a product of the objectivity principle. It emphasizes the need for
accountants not to be influenced by any user, but to prepare accounts based on
acceptable principles.

Where fundamental accounting concepts are followed in the preparation of accounts,


disclosure of such concepts is not necessary unless there is a departure from the fundamental
accounting concepts. However, when selecting accounting policies, rational judgement
should be used; thus, the principles of substance over form, objectivity, fairness, and
materiality can conveniently allow prudence to govern.

A reporting enterprise should disclose the basis used in the preparation of accounts if it is
significant for the understanding and interpretation of a financial statement. The policies
should also be disclosed as an integral part of the financial statements.

Accounting policies should be used consistently to facilitate comparison except where a


different policy will better enhance or reflect net profit or loss of current or subsequent
periods.

110
When there is a change in accounting policy, the nature, justification and the effect on current
year’s profit or loss should be disclosed. Also, cumulative effect of the change on profit and
loss of prior periods should be adjusted in the retained earnings.

3.9.2 Descriptions of Accounting Policies

1. Basis of Accounting

Financial statements are prepared under the historical cost convention except for some fixed
assets which are included at their professional valuation.

2. Consolidation

Group Profit and Loss account and Balance Sheet include the accounts of the company and
all the subsidiaries and the company’s share of profit after tax, less losses of associated
companies.

3. Goodwill

Any excess of the cost of acquisition over the fair values of the net assets is recognized as an
asset in the balance sheet as goodwill arising on acquisition

4. Investments

Investments in subsidiary and associated companies are stated at the lower of cost or the
company’s share of their net tangible asset value at the year end

5. Fixed Assets

Land and buildings are stated at their professional valuation plus additions at cost. Other
fixed assets are stated at cost.

6. Depreciation

Depreciation on a fixed asset is calculated to w rite–off the cost or valuation on a straight line
basis over its expected useful life.

7. Stock and Work in Progress

Stocks are stated at the lower of cost and net realizable value after making adequate provision
for obsolescence and damaged items. In the case of goods manufactured by the company,
cost consists of direct labour, material and appropriate proportion of factory overhead.

8. Turnover

Turnover represents the net value of goods and service invoiced or sold to third party, net of
value added tax (VAT).

111
9. Contract in Progress

These are stated at the values of independent engineers’ certificate for work done but in
respect of which payments were not received at the year end, plus estimated values made by
officials of the company of the realizable value of work done not yet certified.

10. Foreign Currency Conversion

Transactions in foreign currencies are converted into Naira at the prevailing rate ruling at the
date the relevant invoices are received, while assets and liabilities denominated in foreign
currencies are translated at the prevailing rate ruling on the Balance Sheet date

11. Deferred Taxation

Provision is made for deferred taxation by the liability method to take account of all timing
differences between accounting treatment of certain items and their corresponding treatment
for income tax purposes

Self Assessment Exercises

1. Which of the following is not a source of GAAP in Nigeria?

(a) Insurance Act, 2003


(b) Stock Exchange rule
(c) Investment Securities Act
(d) ICAN Act of 1965
(e) CAMA 2004

4.0 CONCLUSION

GAAP includes broad ideas of measurement and classifications as well as rules and
procedures used by accountants in preparing and presenting accounting reports.

5.0 SUMMARY

This unit has explained the meaning and sources of GAAP locally and globally, and the
basic accounting concepts used in Nigeria.

In the next unit, we shall discuss the development, contents and application of accounting
standards.

6.0 TUTOR-MARKED ASSIGNMENT

1. Define the term accounting policies.


2. State two accounting concepts
3. What is the main advantage of historical cost concept?

7.0 REFERENCES/FURTHER READINGS

Adapted from the ICAN Study Packs (2011)

112
UNIT FIVE DEVELOPMENT, CONTENTS AND APPLICATION OF
ACCOUNTING STANDARDS

CONTENTS

1.0 Introduction
2.0 Objectives
3.0 Main Content
3.1 Brief History of Nigeria Accounting Standards Board (NASB)
3.2 Reasons for Establishing NASB
3.3 Composition of the Governing Board of NASB
3.4 Functions of the Board
3.5 Powers of the Board
3.6 NASB Due Process
3.7 The International Accounting Standards Board (IASB)
3.8 Objectives of the IASB
3.9 Structure of the IASB
3.10 The IASB Due Process
3.11 Arguments for and against Standards
3.12 List of Accounting Standards Issued by the NASB
3.13 List of Accounting Standards Issued by International Accounting Standards
Committee/Board (IASC/IASB)
3.14 IFRSs AND SASs Presented Simultaneously
4.0 Conclusion
5.0 Summary
6.0 Tutor-Marked Assignment
7.0 References/Further Readings

1.0 INTRODUCTION

In the last unit, we explained the meaning and sources of GAAP locally and globally, and
the basic accounting concepts used in Nigeria.

In this unit, we shall discuss the development, contents and application of accounting
standards.

2.0 OBJECTIVES

At the end of this unit, you should be able to:

 Explain the process of issuing accounting standards in Nigeria


 Understand the IASB due process
 Explain the composition of Nigerian Accounting Standards Board (NASB)
 Understand NASB due process

3.0 MAIN CONTENT

3.1 Brief History of the Nigerian Accounting Standard Board (NASB)

The Nigerian Accounting Standards Board (NASB) w as established in September, 1982 with
the responsibility of developing accounting standards to be observed in the preparation and
113
presentation of financial statements in Nigeria. Its first legal authority w as the provision of
Section 335(1) of the Companies and Allied Matters Act, 1990, which requires that financial
statements prepared in Nigeria shall comply with the “Statement of Accounting Standards”
issued by the Nigerian Accounting Standards Board. Currently, the full legal authority of the
NASB is provided by the Nigeria Accounting Standards Board Act, 2003 which contains a
wide range of provisions on the establishment, finances and powers of the Board.

3.2 Reasons for Establishing the NASB

The reasons for setting up the NASB, as explained by Godson Nnadi, its Chief Executive, are
to:

(i) Narrow the areas of differences in practices so that financial statements that are
presented to users are structurally uniform and meaningful;

(ii) Produce accounting information that reflect Nigeria’s economic environment while at
the same time satisfying the anticipated needs of users of the information; and

(iii) Introduce measures which will enhance the reliability and velocity of information
reported in financial statements.

3.3 Composition of the Governing Council of the NASB

Under section 2 of the NASB Act 2003, the Governing Council of the NASB shall consist of
the following:

(a) A Chairman who shall be a professional accountant with considerable professional


experience in accounting practices.

(b) Two representatives each of the following


(i) Institute of Chartered Accountants of Nigeria, and
(ii) Association of National Accountants of Nigeria

(c) A representative each of the following:


(i) Federal Ministry of Commerce
(ii) Federal Ministry of Finance
(iii) Central Bank of Nigeria
(iv) Corporate Affairs Commission
(v) Federal Inland Revenue Service
(vi) Nigeria Deposit Insurance Corporation
(vii) Securities and Exchange Commission
(viii) Auditor-General for the Federation
(ix) Accountant – General of the Federation
(x) Chartered Institute of Taxation of Nigeria
(xi) Nigeria Accounting Teachers Association; and
(xii) Nigeria Association of Chambers of Commerce, Industries, Mines and Agriculture

(d) The Executive Secretary of the Board

114
3.4 Functions of the Board

Section 6 of the NASB Act 2003, requires the Board to perform the following functions:

(a) Develop and publish in the public interest, accounting standards to be observed in the
preparation of financial statements.

(b) Promote the general acceptance and adoption of such standards by the preparers and
users of financial statements.

(c) Promote and enforce compliance with the accounting standards developed or reviewed by
the Board.

(d) Review from time to time, the accounting standards developed in line with the prevalent
social, economic and political environment.

(e) Receive from time to time notices of non-compliance with its standards from the
preparer, user or auditor of accounts.

(f) Receive copies of all qualified audit reports together with detailed explanations for such
qualifications from the auditors of the accounts within a period of sixty days from the
date of such qualification.

(g) Advise the supervising Minister on the making of regulations under Section 356 of
CAMA, 2004.

(h) Advise the Federal Government on matters relating to accounting standards.

Perform such other duties which in the opinion of the Council are necessary or expedient to
ensure the efficient performance of the functions of the Board under the Act.

3.5 Powers of the Board

Section 7 of the Act empowers the Board to:

(a) Identify accounting issues which require standardization and establish the order of
priority for addressing them.

(b) Determine the scope and objectives of each standard.

(c) Prescribe the methods and procedure for the production of standards.

(d) Prescribe the time table for the production of each standard.

(e) Approve discussion papers, exposure drafts and standards.

(f) Enforce and approve enforcement of compliance with accounting standards in


Nigeria.

(g) Exercise such powers as are necessary or expedient for giving effect to the provisions
of the Act.
115
3.6 NASB Due Process

The development of a new and proposed accounting standard involves a long process which
ensures that all interested parties are given the opportunity to express their views. This
standard setting process is called Due Process and it can take more than two years in some
cases. The stages involved in the production of a Statement of Accounting Standard (SAS)
are outlined below:

a) The first stage in the development of an accounting standard is the selection of a topic for
standardisation. Such topic can be suggested by any individual or organisation.

b) The next stage is the selection of a steering committee of experts, comprising mainly of
leading authorities in that area. This committee usually includes an accountant in
practice, representative of the affected industry, representative of the Federal Inland
Revenue Service Board, and academia, and at least one person representing the business
community w ho may be affected by the proposed standard” (Nnadi, 2006).

c) The Steering Committee directs the NASB secretariat in drafting or re-drafting) of the
points outline, which details the aspects of the topic to be covered

d) W hen the Steering Committee is satisfied with the points outlined, it is submitted to the
Council for approval

e) Upon the approval of the points outlined by the Council, the steering committee directs
the Secretariat in the preparation of a draft exposure draft. After consideration of the draft
exposure draft, by the steering committee, it is recommended to the Council for approval
as exposure draft

f) The Council usually meets for two working days to meticulously examine the exposure
draft submitted to it. If two-thirds of the members present at the Technical session vote in
favour of its publication, then the document becomes an exposure draft.

g) Each Exposure Draft is exposed for about three months. During this period, recipients of
the document are expected to comment in writing and the NASB may conduct a public
hearing where necessary.

h) Based on comments received from the public, the Exposure Draft may be amended. If an
amended exposure draft is approved by three-quarters of Council members present at its
meetings, it becomes an accounting standard.

3.7 The International Accounting Standards Board (IASB)

In 1973, the International Accounting Standards Committee (IASC) was established to


develop and issue accounting standards that should guide the preparation and presentation of
financial statements, globally. The IASC w as in existence until 2001 by which time it had
issued forty-one International Accounting Standards (IASs). Because of differences in
interpreting the accounting standards issued by the IASC, a new body called standard
interpretations committee (SIC) w as established by the IASC in 1997. As at 2001, the SIC
had issued 32 interpretations, some of which are still applicable to financial statements issued
today.

116
In 2001, there were fundamental changes in the global standard setting body which resulted
in the establishment of a new body called International Accounting Standards Board (IASB),
to take over the responsibilities of the IASC with effect from 1st April, 2001. The IASB now
issues International Financial Reporting Standards (IFRS) in place of International
Accounting Standards (IAS) issued by the IASC.

3.8 Objectives of the IASB

Article 2 of the IASB Constitution sets out the objectives of the IASC foundation, as follows:

(a) To develop, in the public interest, a single set of high quality understandable and
enforceable global accounting standards that require high quality, transparent, and
comparable information in financial statements and other financial reporting to help
participants in world’s capital markets and other users make economic decisions;

(b) To promote the use and rigorous application of those standards

(c) To fulfil the objectives associated with (a) and (b) above, to take account of, as
appropriate, the special needs of small and medium-sized entities and emerging
economics; and

(d) To bring about convergence of national accounting standards and international financial
reporting standards to high quality resolutions

3.9 Structure of the IASB

In accordance with Article 18 of its Constitution, “The International Accounting Standards


Board is an independent, privately-funded accounting standard-setter based in London, U.K.
The Board members come from nine countries and have a variety of functional
backgrounds”.

The IASB structure has the following main features:

(a) Trustees. The trustees are not involved in the standard process of the IASB, but have
responsibility for strategic operational issues such as budgets, operational procedures
of the IASB and appointment of members of the Board, IFRIC and SAC.

(b) The Board. The Board consists of 12 full-time members and 2 part- time members w
ho are appointed by the Trustees, based on their technical skills and other experience.
These members are responsible for the standard setting activities of the IASB.

(c) Standards Advisory Council (SAC). The SAC provides a forum for the IASB to
consult with a range of individuals and organisations affected by the IASB’S work.
The SAC also advises the IASB on a wide range of issues including the IASB’s
agenda and IASB’s project priorities and timetable.

(d) International Financial Reporting Interpretations Committee (IFRIC). The


IFRIC assists the IASB in improving financial reporting by providing timely guidance
and interpretation of international financial reporting standards

117
3.10 The IASB Due Process

As with SASs, the development of IFRSs follows due processes which comprise the
following six stages, according to the IASB’s Due Process Handbook.

Stage 1: Setting the agenda;


Stage 2: Project Planning;
Stage 3: Development and publication of a discussion paper;
Stage 4: Development and publication of an exposure draft;
Stage 5: Development and publication of an IFRS;
Stage 6: Procedures after an IFRS is issued

3.11 Arguments for and against Standards

Arguments for are:

(a) They give accountants and auditors some protection from those who may try to pressurize
them into using improper methods and, therefore, ensure their independence

(b) They ensure that all stakeholders make contributions into the standard formulation and as
such enriches the quality

(c) They usually conform with international accounting standards;

(d) They also conform with all existing law and regulation requirements; for example CAMA
2004, BOFIA 1991, Insurance A ct 2003;

(e) The Standards are reviewed periodically to conform with the latest economic and social
developments; and

(f) The enactment of the NASB Act, 2003, gives it power to enforce compliance with
standard.

Arguments against may be discussed, as follows:

(a) They inhibit initiative as decisions have already been made;

(b) They rarely take account of peculiarities of the individual businesses and

(c) Standards may be `watered – down’, due to exposure to interested parties or intended
users.

3.12 List of Accounting Standards Issued by the NASB

As discussed earlier, the Nigerian Accounting Standards Board is mandated by the NASB
Act 2003, to issue (SAS) from time to time, to guide accounting practice in Nigeria. The
accounting standards so far issued by the NASB, as stated in the Body’s Handbook for
2008/2009, are listed below.

SAS NO TITLE
1 Disclosure of Accounting Policies
118
2 Information to be disclosed in Financial Statements
3 Property, Plants and Equipment
4 Stocks
5 Construction Contracts
6 Extra-ordinary Items and Prior Year Adjustments
7 Foreign Currency Conversion and Translation
8 Accounting for Employees’ Retirement Benefits
9 Accounting for Depreciation
10 Banks and Non-Bank Financial Institutions (Part 1)
11 Leases
12 Accounting for Deferred Taxes (superseded by SAS 19)
13 Accounting for Investments
14 Petroleum Industry: Upstream Activities
15 Banks and Non-Bank Financial Institutions (Part 2)
16 Accounting for Insurance Business
17 Petroleum Industry: Downstream Activities
18 Cash Flow Statements
19 Accounting for Taxes
20 Abridged Financial Statements
21 Earnings per Share
22 Research and Development Cost
23 Provisions, Contingent Liabilities and Contingent Assets
24 Segment Reporting
25 Telecommunications Activities
26 Business Combinations
27 Consolidated and Separate Financial Statements
28 Investments in Associates
29 Interests in Joint Ventures
30 Interim Financial Reporting

3.13 List of Accounting Standards Issued by International Accounting Standards


Committee/Board (IASC/IASB)

International Financial Reporting Standards (IFRSs):

IFRS 1 First-time Adoption of International Financial Reporting standards


IFRS 2 Share-based Payments
IFRS 3 Business Combinations
IFRS 4 Insurance Contracts
IFRS 5 Non-current Assets Held for Sale and Discontinued operations
IFRS 6 Exploration for and Evaluation of Mineral Resources
IFRS 7 Financial Instruments: Disclosures
IFRS 8 Operating Segments

International accounting standards (IASs):

IAS 1 Presentation of Financial Statements


IAS 2 Inventories
IAS 7 Statement of Cash Flows
IAS 8 Accounting Policies, Changes in Accounting Estimates and errors
IAS 10 Events after the Reporting Period
119
IAS 11 Construction Contracts
IAS 12 Income Taxes
IAS 16 Property, Plant And Equipment
IAS 17 Leases
IAS 18 Revenue
IAS 19 Employee Benefits
IAS 20 Accounting for Government Grants and Disclosure of government assistance
IAS 21 The Effects of Changes in Foreign Exchange Rates
IAS 23 Borrowing Costs
IAS 24 Related Party Disclosures
IAS 26 Accounting and Reporting by Retirement Benefit Plans
IAS 27 Consolidated and Separate Financial Statements
IAS 28 Investment in Associates
IAS 29 Financial Reporting in Hyperinflationary Economies
IAS 31 Interests in Joint Venture
IAS 32 Financial Instruments: Presentation
IAS 33 Earnings per Share
IAS 34 Interim Financial Reporting
IAS 36 Impairment of Assets
IAS 37 Provisions, Contingent Liabilities and Contingent Assets
IAS 38 Intangible Assets
IAS 39 Financial Instrument: Recognition and Measurement
IAS 40 Investment Property
IAS 41 Agriculture

Currently valid interpretations issued by the IASB:

IFIC International Financial Reporting Interpreting Committee


SIC Standards International Committee
IFRIC 1 Changes in existing Decommissioning, Restoration and Similar Liabilities
IFRIC 2 Members’ Shares in Co-operative Entities and Similar Instruments
IFRIC 4 Determining whether an Arrangement contains a Lease
IFRIC 5 Rights to Interests Arising from Decommissioning, Restoration and
Environmental Rehabilitation Funds
IFRIC 6 Liabilities arising from Participating in a Specific Market-Waste Electrical and
Electronic Equipment
IFRIC 7 Applying the Restatement Approach under IAS 29 Financial Reporting in
hyperinflationary Economies
IFRIC 8 Scope of IFRS 2
IFRIC 9 Reassessment of Embedded Derivatives
IFRIC 10 Interim Financial Reporting and Impairment
IFRIC 11 IFRS 2 - Group and Treasury Share Transactions
IFRIC 12 Service Concession Arrangements
IFRIC 13 Customer Loyalty Programmes
IFRIC 14 IAS 19 - The Limit on a Defined Benefit Asset, Minimum Funding
Requirements and their Interactions
IFRIC 15 Agreements for the Construction of Real Estate
IFRIC 16 Hedges of a Net Investment in a Foreign Operation
IFRIC 17 Distributions of Non-Cash Assets to Owners.
SIC-7 Introduction of the Euro
SIC-10 Government Assistance - No specific Relation to Operating activities
120
SIC-12 Consolidation - Special Purpose Entities
SIC-13 Jointly Controlled Entities - Non Monetary Contributions by venturers
SIC-15 Operating Leases - Incentives
SIC-21 Income Taxes - Recovery of re-valued Non Depreciable Assets
SIC-25 Income Taxes - Changes in the Tax Status of an Entity or its shareholders
SIC-27 Evaluating the Substance of Transactions involving the Legal Form of a lease
SIC-29 Service Concession Arrangements: Disclosures
SIC-31 Revenue - Barter Transactions involving Advertising Services
SIC-32 Intangible Assets - Web Site Costs

3.14 IFRSs AND SASs Presented Simultaneously

International Financial Reporting Standards (IFRSs) Relating statement of


Accounting stds (SASs)
IFRS 1 First time adoption of international financial None
Reporting standards
IFRS 2 Share based payments None
IFRS 3 Business combinations SAS 26
IFRS 4 Insurance contracts SAS 16
IFRS 5 Non-current assets held for sale and None
Discontinued operations
IFRS 6 Exploration for and evaluation of mineral SAS 14
Resources
IFRS 7 Financial instruments: disclosures SAS 10 and15
IFRS 8 Operating segments
SAS 24
International Accounting Standards (IASs)
IAS 1 Presentation of financial statements SAS 1 &2
IAS 2 Inventories SAS 4
IAS 7 Statement of cash flows SAS 18
IAS 8 Accounting policies, changes in Accounting SAS 6
Estimates and errors
IAS 10 Events after the reporting period None
IAS 11 Construction contracts SAS 5
IAS 12 Income taxes SAS 19
IAS 16 Property, plant and equipment SAS 3
IAS 17 Leases SAS 11
IAS 18 Revenue None
IAS 19 Employee benefits SAS 8
IAS 20 Accounting for government grants and None
disclosure of government assistance
IAS 21 The effects of change in foreign exchange rates SAS 7
IAS 23 Borrowing costs None
IAS 24 Related party disclosures None
IAS 26 Accounting and reporting by retirement benefit SAS 8
plans
IAS 27 Consolidated and separate financial statements SAS 27
IAS 28 Investment in associates SAS 28
IAS 29 Financial reporting in hyper inflationary None yet
economies
121
IAS 31 Interests in joint venture SAS 29
IAS 32 Financial instruments: presentation SAS 10 & 15
IAS 33 Earnings per share SAS 21
IAS 34 Interim financial reporting SAS 30
IAS 36 Impairment of assets SAS 9
IAS 37 Provisions, contingent liabilities and contingent SAS 23
assets
IAS 38 Intangible assets
IAS 39 Financial instruments: recognition and SAS 10 & 15
measurement
IAS 40 Investment property SAS 13
IAS 41 Agriculture SAS 4

Self Assessment Exercises

1. One argument in favour of statement of accounting standards is they conform with existing
____ and ______ requirements.

2. Operating segments are disclosed under IFRS ______ and SAS _____

3. ______ is the maximum period for receiving comments on an exposure draft


a) 12months
b) 3months
c) 6months
d) 5months
e) 2months

4.0 CONCLUSION

The full legal authority of the NASB is provided by the Nigerian Accounting Standards
Board Act, 2003. This contains a wide range of provisions on the establishment, and powers
of the board. The unit goes on to outline the International Accounting Standards (global) and
their sister Statements of Accounting Standards (local).

5.0 SUMMARY

This unit has discussed the composition, function and powers of the NASB and IASB as well
as its due process, objectives, structure and the standard setting processes.

In the next unit, we shall be examining the regulatory framework of financial accounting.

6.0 TUTOR-MARKED ASSIGNMENT

1. List the due processes of IASB and compare this with that of NASB.
2. Why NASB established and what are the functions of the Board?
3. What are the arguments for and against Standards? List some of them that you know.
4. Briefly list and explain the structure of IASB.
5. What are the objectives of IASB? List some of them.

122
7.0 REFERENCES/FURTHER READINGS

Adapted from the ICAN Study Packs (2011)

123
UNIT SIX REGULATORY FRAMEWORK OF FINANCIAL
ACCOUNTING

CONTENTS

1.0 Introduction
2.0 Objectives
3.0 Main Content
3.1 Banks and Other Financial Institutions Act, 1991 (BOFIA)
3.2 Insurance Act, 2003
3.3 SEC and NSE Regulations
3.4 Investment and Securities Act, 1999
3.5 Pensions Reform Act, 2004
4.0 Conclusion
5.0 Summary
6.0 Tutor-Marked Assignment
7.0 References/Further Readings

1.0 INTRODUCTION

In the last unit, we discussed extensively the development, contents and application of
accounting standards.

In this unit, we shall discuss the regulatory framework of financial accounting.

2.0 OBJECTIVES

At the end of this unit, you should be able to:

 Discuss the accounting requirements of the Insurance act 2003, BOFIA 1991, and
Investment and Securities act 1999, Securities and Exchange Commission and Nigerian
Stock Exchange.

 List and explain the accounting methods recommended by Pension Reform act 2004.

3.0 MAIN CONTENT

3.1 Banks and Other Financial Institutions Act, 1991 (BOFIA)

The statutory backing for the establishment and regulation of Banks and Other Non-Bank
Financial Institutions (Discount Houses, Finance Houses, e.t.c except Insurance Companies)
in Nigeria is the Banks and Other Financial Institutions A ct, 1991 (as amended). Some of the
accounting requirements of the Act are stated below.

Minimum Capital

The President shall on the advice of the Central Bank of Nigeria (CBN) determine, from time
to time, the appropriate minimum paid up share capital of each category of banks subject to
subsection (1) of this Section. The minimum shareholders’ fund of banking institutions shall
in respect of:

124
(a) Universal Banks be N25 billion
(b) Bureau de Change be N500 million
(c) Micro finance banks be N 20 million
(d) Mortgage Institutions be N2 billion

Cash Reserves, Special Deposits and Specified Liquid Assets

The BOFIA requires every bank to maintain with the CBN, cash reserves and special deposit
and hold specified liquid assets or stabilization securities, as the case may be, as prescribed
by the Central Bank by virtue of Section 39 of Central Bank of Nigeria Act, 1991 (as
amended) where both assets and /liabilities are due.

For the purpose of this section, specified liquid assets are:

(a) Currency notes and coins which are legal tender in Nigeria;

(b) Balances at the bank;

(c) Net balances at any licensed bank and money at call in Nigeria;

(d) Treasury bills and treasury certificates issued by the Federal Government

(e) Inland bills of exchange and promissory notes re - discountable at the Central Bank

(f) Stock issued by the Federal Government with such dates of maturity as may be approved
by the Central Bank; and

(g) Negotiable Certificate of deposit approved by the Central Bank.

(h) Such other negotiable instruments as may from time to time be approved by the Central
Bank.

Statutory Reserve Fund

The Act also requires every bank to maintain a reserve fund. Each year, a bank must transfer
an amount to the reserve fund, equal to and not less than 30% of the profit after tax, if the
amount in the reserve is less than the paid – up share capital, and 15% of the profit after tax,
if the amount in the reserve fund is equal or greater than the paid – up share capital.

Conditions for payment of Dividends

No bank shall pay dividend until:

(a) All its preliminary expenses, organizational expenses, share selling expenses, brokerage,
losses incurred and other capitalized expenses not represented by tangible assets have
been written–off

(b) Adequate provision has been made for contingent losses on risk assets liabilities, off
balance sheet commitment; and

(c) It has complied with capital ratio requirement specified by Section 13(1) of the act
125
3.1.1 Reserve for Small Scale Industries

CBN Monetary and Credit Policies require each Bank to set aside 10 percent of its profits for
the financing and promotion of Small Scale Industries in Nigeria

3.1.2 Analysis of non-performing loans and advances

Prudential guidelines issued by the CBN require banks to classify non-performing loans and
advances, and to provide for loan impairment as follows:

Interest and principal outstanding for over


Classification Provision
90 days but less than 180 days substandard 10%
180 days but less than 360 days doubtful 50%
360 days and over lost 100%

3.2 Insurance Act, 2003

The regulatory body for the Insurance Industry is the National Insurance Commission
(NAICOM), while the regulatory statute is the Insurance Act, 2003 (as amended). Relevant
sections of the statute are summarised below:

Minimum paid up capital (section 9(1))

The Act mandates every insurance business in Nigeria to maintain specified minimum paid
up capital which has been reviewed by NAICOM as follows:

(a) Life Insurance not less than N 2 billion;


(b) General Insurance not less than N3 billion;
(c) Composite Insurance Business not less than N 5 billion
(d) Reinsurance business not less than N 10 billion

Statutory deposit (section 10)

This Section requires that:

(a) An insurer intending to commence insurance business in Nigeria, after the


commencement of the Act, shall deposit the equivalent of 50 percent of the Paid-Up
Share Capital, referred to above, with the Central Bank of Nigeria. This deposit is called
Statutory Deposit.

(b) Upon registration as an insurer, 80 per cent of the statutory deposit shall be returned with
interest not later than 60 days after registration.

(c) In the case of existing companies, an equivalent of 10 per cent of the minimum paid-up
share capital stipulated in Section 9, shall deposited with the CBN

(d) Statutory Deposit shall attract interest at the minimum lending rate by the CBN on every
1 January of each year

(e) Any short fall in the statutory deposit must be replenished within 30 days
126
Statutory books and records (section 17 and 18)

Section 17(1), requires an insurer to keep and maintain at its principal office, the following
records:

(a) The Memorandum and Articles of Association or other evidence of the Constitution of
the insurer.

(b) A record containing the names and addresses of the owners of the insurance business,
whether known as, or called shareholders or otherwise.

(c) The minutes of any meeting of the owners and of the policy making executives (whether
known as or called the Board of Directors).

(d) A register of all policies, in which shall be entered, in respect of every policy issued, the
names and addresses of the policy-holders, the date when policy was effected and a
record on any transfer, assignment or nomination of which the insurer has notice.

(e) A register of claims, in which shall be entered, every claim made together with the date
of claim, the names and addresses of the claimant and the date on which the claim was
settled, or in the case of claim which is repudiated, the grounds for the rejection or in the
case of litigation, the particulars of the litigants and the court in this matter.

(f) A register of investments, showing those which are attributable to the insurance funds
and those which are not, and also any alteration in their values, from time to time.

(g) A register of its assets.

(h) A register of re-insurance ceded, showing separately those ceded in Nigeria and those
ceded outside Nigeria.

(i) A cash book.

(j) A current account book.

(k) A register of open policies, in respect of marine insurance transactions and management
report by external auditors.

Section 17(2), requires a life insurance business, to maintain and keep the following
additional records:

(a) A register of assured, under group policies;


(b) A register of loans on policies;
(c) A register of cash surrendered values; and
(d) A register of lapsed and expired policies.

Section 18(1), mandates a re-insurance business, to keep and maintain at its principal office,
the following records:

(a) The Memorandum and Articles of Association or other evidence of the Constitution of
the reinsurer
127
(b) Records containing the names and addresses of the owners of the reinsurer (whether
known as or called shareholders or otherwise);

(c) Minutes of any meeting of the owners and of the policy making executives (whether
known as the board of directors or otherwise);

(d) A register of all treaties, in which shall be entered, in respect of every treaty issued, the
name of the cedant, and the date when the treaty was effected;

(e) A register of all claims, in which shall be entered, every claim made together with the
date of claim, the name of the cedant or insured, their proportionate share and the date the
claim is settled;

(f) A register of events, showing those which are attributable to the insurance funds and
those which are not and also any alteration in value from time to time;

(g) A register of Assets;

(h) A register of business or retrocession, showing separately those ceded within and outside
Nigeria;

(i) A register of new and existing clients;

(j) A cashbook; and

(k) Domestic or management report prepared by the external auditors.

A life reinsurance business, shall keep the following additional records:

(a) A register of assured, under group policies;


(b) A register of cancelled, leased and expired policies, and
(c) A register of claims, showing the names of the deceased and when the claim is settled.

Separation of Accounts and Insurance Funds (section 19)

Section 19(1), requires every insurer, who carries on the two classes of insurance business, to
enter all receipts of each of those classes of insurance business, in a separate and distinct
account. Separate insurance funds are also required for each class of insurance business and,
in the case of life insurance business, there should be:

(a) the individual life insurance business fund;


(b) the group life insurance business and pension fund; and
(c) health insurance business.

Section 19(2), contains the following additional requirements:

(a) In the case of life insurance business, the life business funds, shall be a sum not less than
the mathematical reserve; and

(b) In the case of general insurance business, the insurer is required to maintain provisions
for unexpired risk and provisions for outstanding claims, including in the case of the
128
latter, provisions estimated to provide for the expenses of adjustment or settlement of
such claims.

The insurance fund of each particular class, shall:

(a) be absolutely the security of the policy holders of that class, as though it belongs to an
insurer carrying on other business than insurance business of that class

(b) not be liable for any contract of the insurer for which it would not have been liable, had
the business of the insurer been only that of particular insurance class; and

(c) not be applied directly or indirectly, for a purpose other than those of the class of
business, to which the fund is applicable.

Technical reserves (sections 20-23)

Section 20(1), requires an insurer, in respect of its general business, to establish and maintain
the following provisions applicable in respect of each class of insurance business:

(a) Provisions for unexpired risks which shall be calculated on a time appointment basis of
the risks accepted in the year.

(b) Provisions for outstanding claims which shall be credited with an amount equal to the
total estimated amount of all outstanding claims with a further amount representing 10
per cent of the estimated figure for outstanding claims in respect of claims incurred but
not reported at the end of the year under review and
Under section 21

(a) An insurer shall establish and maintain contingency reserves to cover fluctuations in
securities and variations in statistical estimates.

(b) The contingency reserves shall be credited with an amount not less than 3 per cent of
the total premium or 20 per cent of the net profit (whichever is greater) and the
amount shall accumulate until it reaches the amount of the minimum paid up capital
or 50 percent of the of the net premium (whichever is greater).

Section 22(1), requires an insurer maintain the following reserves in respect of its life
insurance business.

(a) A general reserve fund which shall be credited with an amount equal to the net liabilities
on policies in force at the time of the actuarial valuation and an additional 25 per cent of
net premium for every year between valuation date; and

(b) A contingency reserve fund which shall be credited with an amount which shall be
credited with an amount equal to 1 per cent of the gross premium or 10 per cent of the
profit (whichever is greater) and accumulated until it reaches the amount of the minimum
paid up capital

A reinsurer shall establish a general reserve fund which shall be credited with an amount:

129
(a) Not less than 50 per cent of the reinsurer’s gross profit for the year, where the fund is less
than the authorised capital of the insurer; and

(b) Not less than 25 per cent of the reinsurer’s gross profit for the year, where the fund is
equal to or exceeds the authorised capital of the reinsurer.

Margin of safety (section 24(1))

The Act further requires an insurer to maintain at all times, in respect of its general business,
a margin of solvency, being the excess of the value of its admissible assets in Nigeria over its
liabilities in Nigeria, consisting of:

(a) Provision for unexpired risks;


(b) Provisions for outstanding claims;
(c) Provision for claims incurred but not yet reported; and
(d) Funds to meet other liabilities.

The margin of solvency shall not be less than 15 per cent of the gross premium income less
reinsurance premium paid out during the year under review or the minimum paid up capital,
whichever is greater.

The Act defines “admissible assets” as those designated as admissible assets, consisting of
the following:

(a) cash and bank balances;


(b) quoted investment at market value;
(c) unquoted stock at cost;
(d) land and buildings;
(e) furniture and fittings;
(f) office equipment;
(g) motor vehicles;
(h) prepared expenses made to members of staff;
(i) amount due from retrocession;
(j) staff loans and advances; and
(k) claims receivable.

Assets and investments (section 25)

An insurer, shall at all times, in respect of the insurance transacted by it in Nigeria, invest and
hold in Nigeria assets equivalent to not less than the amount of policy holders’ funds in such
insurance business, as shown in the balance sheet and the revenue account of the insurer.

Subject to the provisions of this Section, the policy holders’ funds shall not be invested in
property and securities except:

(a) shares of limited liability companies;


(b) shares in other securities of a co-operative society
(c) registered under a law of relating to cooperative societies
(d) loans to building societies approved by the Commission;
(e) loans on real property, machinery and plant in Nigeria;
(f) loans on life policies within their surrender values;
130
(g) cash deposit in bills of exchange accepted by license banks; and
(h) such investments as may be prescribed by the Commission.

No insurer, shall:

(a) in respect of its general insurance business, invest more than 25 per centum of its assets
in real property; or

(b) in respect of its life insurance business, invest more than 35 per centum of its assets as
defined in subsection (1), in real property.

3.3 Securities and Exchange Commission (SEC) and the Nigerian Stock Exchange
(NSE) Regulations

In most jurisdictions, the Securities and Exchange Commission (SEC) exists as the apex
capital market institution, providing the right regulatory framework for orderly development
of the market, ensuring the integrity of securities business and protection of all participants,
particularly the investors. The extent of powers and scope of regulatory responsibilities
conferred on the Commission depends on enabling laws. In Nigeria, the Commission came
into full existence following the enactment of Securities and Exchange Commission Act
1979, re-enacted as Act 29 of 1988. Historically, it grew out of the Capital Issues Committee,
housed under the Central Bank of Nigeria in the sixties.

This Committee led to the establishment of Capital Issues Commission and subsequently
Nigerian Securities Exchange Commission (NSEC), which played key role in the
indigenization era of 1973–1977 periods. Roles assigned to the Commission can be broadly
classified into developmental and surveillance roles.

3.3.1 Developmental Roles

These relate to efforts aimed at increasing the depth and breadth of securities business and
include facilitating the establishment of important capital market institutions such as Stock
and Commodity Exchanges, Capital Trade Points, Rating Agencies. These roles which are
largely by SEC in developing markets also include development of innovative instruments
such as derivatives and facilitating knowledge and awareness of securities.

The traditional role of surveillance includes oversight responsibilities in ensuring that


existing institutions and participants conform to rules and regulations. Originally, the
following specific functions were taken up by the Commission.

 Pricing of new issues- Following deregulations of the market, this function has been
transferred to the Issuing House

 Timing of issues- This is to ensure that the market is not glutted with shares at any point
in time

 Registering and licensing- of market operators including the stock exchanges

 Approval of allotment of shares to members of the public

131
 Registering of instruments issued with the possibility of transfer to persons other than
those initially offered.

 The Companies and Allied Matters A ct, Cap. C20 LFN 2004 also empowers the
Commission to regulate mergers and acquisitions including unit trust and similar
schemes.

The enabling Act for the activities of the Securities and Exchange Commission is the
Investment and Securities Act, 1999.

3.4 Investments and Securities Act, 1999

The Securities and Exchange Commission is empowered by the Investment and Securities
Act (ISA) 1999, to administer securities laws and regulate investment and securities business
in Nigeria. The Act requires comprehensive set of accounting records and accounting reports
in a number of circumstances, including business combinations, content of prospectus, and
records of security dealers. A few of these requirements are stated below.

Books of Accounts of Security Dealers (s.37)

Section 37 (1) requires a security dealer to keep or cause to be kept such accounting and other
records:

(a) as shall sufficiently explain the transactions and financial position of its business accounts
and balance sheets to be prepared, from time to time; and

(b) in such a manner as to enable them to be conveniently and properly audited.

A security dealer shall be deemed not to have complied with subsection (1) of this Section in
relation to records unless the accounting and other records:

(a) are kept in sufficient details to show particulars of:

(1) all money received or paid by the security dealer including money paid to or
deducted from a trust account;

(2) all purchases and sales of securities made by the security dealer, the charges and
credits arising from them, and the names of each of these securities;

(3) all income received from commissions, interest and other sources and all
expenses, commissions and interest paid for by the security dealer;

(4) all the assets and liabilities (including contingent liabilities) of the security dealer;

(5) All securities which are the priority of the security dealer, showing by whom the
securities or documents of the title to the security are held and, where they are
held by another person, whether or not they are held as security against loans or
advances;

(6) All securities that are not the property of the security dealer and for which the
dealer or any nominee controlled by the security dealer is accountable, showing
132
by whom, and for whom, the securities are held and the extent to which they are
either held for safe custody or deposited with a third party as security for loans or
advances made to the security dealer;

(7) All purchases and sales of options made by the security dealer and all fees (being
options money) arising from them; and

(8) All underwriting transactions entered into by the security dealer.

(b) are kept in sufficient details to show separately particulars of all transactions by the
security dealer.

(c) specify the day on which or the period during which each transaction by the security
dealer took place; and

(d) contain copies of acknowledgements of the receipt of securities or of documents of


title to securities received by the security dealer from clients for sale or safe custody,
clearly showing the name or names in which the particular securities are registered.

Accounts for investor protection fund

Section 152 of ISA 1999, requires a Security Exchange or Capital Trade Point to establish
and keep proper books of accounts in relation to its Investors Protection Fund and prepare
income and expenditure account and balance sheet not later than 30th April following each
31st December.

Accountants’ report to be set out in a prospectus

Section 17 of the 3rd Schedule, requires the report of accountants to be contained in the
prospectus of a company wishing to issue shares or debentures. The report should cover (a)
the profits and losses of the business for the five years preceding the issue of the prospectus
and (b) the assets and liabilities of the business at the last date to which the accounts of the
business were made.

Part 2 of Schedule 4, also requires accountants’ report w here there is a proposal to acquire a
business or a subsidiary.

3.5 Pensions Reform Act, 2004

Section 1 of the Pension Reform Act 2004 mandates the establishment of a Contributory
Pension Scheme for the payment of retirement benefits of workers in Nigeria. Section 2 of
the Act insists that the requirement is applicable to employees in both private and public
sectors, thereby setting aside the use of defined benefit plan permitted by SAS 8, Accounting
for employee retirement benefits.

Self Assessment Exercises

1. Mention at least two major roles of security and exchange commission

2. One of the following is not allowed as a liquid asset for banks in Nigeria:
a) Treasury bills
133
b) Shares issued the federal government
c) Coins and notes on legal tender
d) Bonds by state governments
e) Balances with discount houses

4.0 CONCLUSION

There are statutory documents that govern financial accounting in Nigeria and these in turn
form the regulatory framework of financial accounting.

5.0 SUMMARY

This unit highlights the important provisions of CAMA, insurance at 2003, BOFIA 1991 and
investment securities act 1999, as they govern financial accounting in Nigeria.

With the end of discussion in this unit, we have come to the end of module two of this course.

6.0 TUTOR-MARKED ASSIGNMENT

Write short notes on the following:

 Banks and Other Financial Institutions Act, 1991 (BOFIA)


 Insurance Act, 2003
 SEC and NSE Regulations
 Investment and Securities Act, 1999
 Pensions Reform Act, 2004

7.0 REFERENCES/FURTHER READINGS

Adapted from the ICAN Study Packs (2011)

134
MODULE THREE

Unit 1 Legal and Regulatory Framework of Group Accounts


Unit 2 Consolidated Balance Sheet
Unit 3 Consolidated Profit and Loss Account
Unit 4 Associated Companies
Unit 5 Disposal of Subsidiaries
Unit 6 Group Cash Flow

UNIT ONE LEGAL AND REGULATORY FRAMEWORK OF GROUP


ACCOUNTS

CONTENTS

1.0 Introduction
2.0 Objectives
3.0 Main Content
3.1 Group of Companies
3.2 Regulatory Documents
3.3 The Need for Group Accounts
3.4 Group Financial Statements
3.5 Parent/Holding Company and Subsidiaries
3.6 Uniform Accounting Policies
3.7 Co-Terminus Accounting Dates
3.8 Methods of Preparing Consolidated Accounts
3.9 Application of Purchase Method
3.10 Forms of Group Accounts
3.11 Exemption of Subsidiaries from Consolidation
3.12 Treatment of an Enterprise that ceases to be a Subsidiary
3.13 Disclosure Requirements for Subsidiaries Excluded from Consolidation
3.14 Consolidation Procedures under SAS 27
3.15 Disclosure Requirements under SAS 27
4.0 Conclusion
5.0 Summary
6.0 Tutor-Marked Assignment
7.0 References/Further Readings

1.0 INTRODUCTION

You are welcome to module three and the first unit of the module in this course.

In this unit, we shall discuss the legal and regulatory framework of group accounts.

2.0 OBJECTIVES

At the end of this unit, you should be able to:

 Explain the theoretical background and regulatory documents for the preparation and
presentation consolidation of financial statements.

135
 Describe the conditions required for an enterprise to be a subsidiary, an associate of a
group or a joint entity.

 Enumerate the forms of group accounts.

3.0 MAIN CONTENT

3.1 Group of Companies

Combinations based on the purchase of controlling shares by one company in another


company, directly or indirectly, give rise to a group of companies within which the company
that purchased the controlling shares is called the parent or `holding company’ and the
company whose shares are acquired is referred to as the ‘subsidiary company’.

Combinations of this nature do not affect the existence of the combined companies, as
separate legal entities. However, this transfer of control from one group of owners to another
affects the economic substance of members of the group. To this effect, the operations of
group companies and the preparation of consolidated financial statements are regulated by an
Act and International Accounting Standards.

3.2 Regulatory Documents

The regulatory documents for establishing group of companies for the preparing the group
accounts are as follows:

(a) The companies and Allied Matters Act Cap.C20 LFN 2004, later called the Act;

(b) Statement of Accounting Standards (SAS) 26- on Business combination;

(c) Statement of Accounting Standards (SAS) 27 – On Consolidated and Separate Financial


Statements;

(d) Statement of Accounting Standards (SAS) 28 – On Investment in Associates;

(e) International Accounting Standard (IAS) 31 - On Interests in Joint ventures.

3.3 The Need for Group Accounts

In Nigeria, the main reporting obligations of directors of parent companies are contained in
the Companies and Allied Matters Act 2004. Section 336 of the Act, requires the directors of
a company that has subsidiaries, at the end of the year, to prepare its individual accounts for
that year and the group financial statements. These statements report on the state of affairs,
the profit and loss of the company and its subsidiaries.

The objective is to provide the shareholders of the parent company with full information
concerning the activities of the entire economic unit in which they have invested. This is
achieved by combining all the assets and liabilities of the parent company and its subsidiaries
into a single balance sheet so as to disclose the overall financial position of the group.

136
3.4 Group Financial Statements

A group is defined as a parent company and its subsidiaries. Group financial statements are
the financial statements of the parent company and its subsidiaries combined to form a set of
consolidated financial statements.

Consolidated financial statements are the financial statements of a group presented as those
of a single enterprise. In accordance with the Act, the group’s financial statements shall
consist of three statements, as follows:

(a) Consolidated balance sheet dealing with the state of affairs of the company and all the
subsidiaries of the company;

(b) Consolidated profit and loss account of the company and its subsidiaries; and

(c) Consolidated statement of cash flows of the company and its subsidiaries.

It is not necessary to publish the parent company’s profit and loss account, provided the
company’s consolidated profit and loss accounts contains a note stating how much of the
parent company’s profit and loss is dealt with in the accounts (CAMA 2004).

3.5 Parent/Holding Company and Subsidiaries

A holding company is one that has one or more subsidiaries. A subsidiary is an enterprise that
is controlled by another enterprise known as the parent.

Under Section 338 of the Act, a company (say company A) shall be deemed to be the
subsidiary of another company (say company B) if:

(a) the company (company B) is a member of it and controls the composition of its board
of directors; or

(b) holds more than half the nominal value of its equity share capital; or

(c) the first mentioned company (company A) is a subsidiary of any company which is a
subsidiary of company B.

For the purpose of the Act, the composition of the board of directors of a company shall be
deemed to be controlled by another company if that other company has the power to remove
all or a majority of the directors without the consent or concurrence of another party.

Generally control is presumed to exist when the parent owns, directly or indirectly, through
subsidiaries more than one half of the voting power of an enterprise.

SAS 27 defines control as the power to govern the financial and operating policies of an
entity so as to obtain benefits from its activities. Under the standard, control is also presumed
to exist when the parent has:

1. Power over more than half the voting right by virtue of agreement with other investors.

137
2. Power to govern the financial and operating polices of the enterprise under a statute or
agreement.

3. Power to appoint or remove the majority of the members of the board of directors.

4. Power to cast the majority of votes at a meeting of board of directors or equivalent


governing body and control of the entity is by that board or body.

Illustration 13-1

Company X is said to be a subsidiary of company Y when:

(1) Company Y is a member of company X and controls the composition of the Board of
directors (BOD). This means that company Y has the power to appoint or remove all
or the majority of members of the BOD and power to cast majority of votes at the
meeting of the BOD.

(2) Company Y owns more than half of the nominal value of the equity share capital.
This is the power to govern the financial and operating policies of the enterprise under
a statute or an agreement.

(3) Company X is a subsidiary of another company Z, which is itself a subsidiary of


company Y. In this case, Company Y would exercise control over company X
indirectly.

3.6 Uniform Accounting Policies (SAS 27)

As much as possible, uniform accounting policies should be employed by the members of a


group when preparing the accounts of their individual companies.

SAS 27 specifically requires an entity to use uniform accounting policies for reporting such
transactions and other events in similar circumstances. Where a subsidiary has not adopted a
uniform policy, appropriate adjustments should be made to its financial statements in
preparing the consolidated financial statements (see para. 38 and 11).

3.7 Co-Terminus Accounting Dates

A subsidiary is required to prepare its own financial statements at or to the same date as the
group.

If a subsidiary does not prepare its own financial statements at the same date as that of the
group, adjustments should be made for the effects of significant transactions or events that
occur between that date and the date adopted by the parent. The difference between the
reporting date of the subsidiary and that of the parent shall not be more than three months.

When it is not possible to obtain such special financial statements, appropriate adjustments
should be made to the consolidated financial statements for any abnormal transactions in the
intervening period. The consolidated accounts should disclose:

(i) The name of the subsidiary;


(ii) Its accounting date; and
138
(iii) The reason for using different dates

3.8 Methods of Preparing Consolidated Accounts

SAS 27 prescribes that all business combinations shall be accounted for by applying the
purchase method. The method has the following features:

(i) Assets and liabilities of the subsidiaries are measured at fair market value at the date
of acquisition;

(ii) Shares purchased and issued in settlement of the purchase are valued by the parent
company at fair value.

(iii) The profits of the subsidiary are divided into pre-acquisition and post-acquisition
periods. Only the post-acquisition profits are consolidated.

(iv) Goodwill arises on consolidation when the fair value of the consideration is different
from the fair value of the net asset acquired.

3.9 Application of Purchase Method

Application of the purchase method involves the following steps:

(a) Identifying an acquirer. The acquirer is the combining entity that obtains control of
the other combining entities.

(b) Measuring the cost of the business combination.

(c) Allocating the cost of the business combination to the assets acquired and liabilities
and contingent liabilities assumed at the acquisition date.

3.10 Forms of Group Accounts

Section 336(5) of the Act states that a parent company should prepare group accounts in the
form of a single set of financial statements. It however allows for alternative forms of group
accounts where in the opinion of the directors, the other form would present the same or
better view of the group’s performance and financial position.

Other forms of accounting for group interests available are:

(a) more than one set of consolidated financial statements dealing respectively with the
company and one group of subsidiaries and with other groups of subsidiaries; or

(b) separate financial statements dealing with each of the subsidiaries; or

(c) statements expanding the information about subsidiaries in individual financial


statements of the company or in any other form.

3.11 Exemption of Subsidiaries from Consolidation

Under the act:


139
(a) Under Section 336(2) of the Act, group accounts need not be prepared where the
parent company itself is at the end of its financial year, a wholly owned subsidiary of
another company incorporated in Nigeria. However, w here the ultimate parent
company is incorporated overseas; the group accounts should be prepared.

(b) Under Section 336(3) of the Act, a subsidiary may be omitted from the group
accounts if:

(i) it is impracticable or would be of no real value to members because of the


insignificant amount involved;

(ii) it would involve expenses or delay out of proportion to its value to members
of the company;

(iii) the result would be misleading or harmful to the business of the company or
any of its subsidiaries. For instance, it may be harmful to consolidate the result
of a subsidiary with operating losses, poor liquidity position and massive
borrowing; or

(iv) the business of the parent company and that of the subsidiary are so different
that they cannot reasonably be treated as a single undertaking.

Under SAS 27 of the Act, a parent need not present consolidated financial statements if, and
only if, all the following conditions apply:

(a) The parent is itself a wholly-owned subsidiary, or the parent is a partially-owned


subsidiary of another entity and its other owners have been informed about and do not
object to the parent not preparing consolidated financial statements.

(b) The parent’s debt or equity instruments are not traded in a public market.

(c) The parent did not file nor is in the process of filing its financial statements with the
Securities and Exchange Commission or other regulatory organizations for the
purpose of issuing any class of instrument in a public market.

(d) The ultimate or any intermediate parent of the parent, produces financial statements
when the parents elect or are required by local regulations to present separate
financial statements.

(e) The subsidiary is acquired with the intention to dispose of the company within 12
months and management is actively seeking a buyer.

(f) When the parent company loses control. The loss of control can occur with or without
a change in absolute or relative ownership levels. For example, where a subsidiary
becomes subject to the control of a government, court, administrator or regulator.

A subsidiary is not excluded from consolidation because its activities are dissimilar from
those of other entities within the group. Relevant information is provided by consolidating
such subsidiaries and disclosing additional information in the consolidated financial
statements about the different activities of the subsidiaries.

140
Similarly, an entity is not permitted to exclude from consolidation a subsidiary it continues to
control simply because that entity is operating under severe long term restrictions that
significantly impair its ability to transfer funds to the parent. Control must be lost for
exclusion to occur (SAS 27 para. 21).

3.12 Treatment of an Enterprise that ceases to be a Subsidiary

When an enterprise ceases to be a subsidiary, the investment in the enterprise shall be


accounted for in accordance with other SASs from the date when control is lost.

3.13 Disclosure Requirements for Subsidiary Excluded from Consolidation

Under the Act

When a company is not a wholly owned subsidiary of another company incorporated in


Nigeria, the directors of the company should state the reason for the exclusion of the
subsidiary from consolidation. Schedule II paragraph 68 of the Act states that the notes to the
accounts should include:

(a) the reasons why the subsidiaries are not dealt with in group accounts;

(b) any qualifications by the auditors of the subsidiaries’ accounts not covered by the
company’s own accounts;

(c) the aggregate amount of the total investment of the parent company in the shares of
the subsidiaries, for:

(i) the financial year under consideration; and


(ii) previous years since acquisition.

(d) such investments should be accounted for using the equity method of valuation;

(e) where any of the information in (a) to (d) above are not obtainable, a statement to that
effect shall be given.

Under SAS 27, a parent that is exempted from presenting consolidated financial statements in
accordance with the standard shall present separate financial statements as its only
statements.

3.14 Explanation of Terms under Group Accounts

(a) Equity share capital

This comprises any equity share capital which carries the right to participate beyond a
specified amount in either a capital or revenue distribution. Therefore, it includes all
share capital other than non-participating preference shares.

In the absence of information to the contrary, ordinary shares are assumed to be


equity while preference shares are not.

141
(b) Equity method of accounting

This is a method of accounting where the investment in a company is shown in the


consolidated balance sheet at:

(i) the cost of the investment; plus

(ii) the investing company or group’s share of the post-acquisition retained profits
and reserves of the company; less

(iii) any amount written off in respect of (i) and (ii) above. The investing company
should account separately in the profit and loss account for its share of the
profit before tax, taxation and extraordinary items of the acquired company.

This method is usually applied to associated companies under the provisions of


SAS28.

(c) Related company

The Act defines a related company as any body corporate (other than that which is a
group company in relation to that company) in which that company holds on a long-
term basis, a qualifying capital interest for the purpose of securing a contribution to
that company’s own activities by exercising control or influence arising from that
interest. Related companies are described by SAS 28 as associated companies.

(d) Associated companies

This is an enterprise in which the investor has significant influence and which is
neither a subsidiary nor a joint venture of the investor.

Significant influence is the power to participate in the financial and operating policy
decisions of the investee but does not have control over those policies. A holding of
20 percent but less than 50% of the equity voting rights is regarded as the ability to
exercise significant influence (though not in all circumstances).

(e) Fellow subsidiaries

A body corporate is treated as a fellow subsidiary of another body corporate, if both


are subsidiaries of the same company, but neither is the other’s subsidiary.

(f) Cost of control account

It is described as an account opened to record the purchase of a business so as to


determine whether the business is being purchased at a ‘profit or at a loss’. In other
words, it is a goodwill account. A debit balance on the Cost of Control account is
regarded as a loss on purchase because the cost of shares acquired is greater than the
net assets acquired while a Credit balance on the Cost of Control is regarded as a gain
(i.e. Negative Goodwill). In the cost of control account, the cost of investment is
cancelled against the net assets acquired to determine goodwill.

142
(g) Goodwill on consolidation

Goodwill is the difference between the price paid by the parent company and the fair
value of the subsidiary’s net assets at the date of acquisition. Included in the definition
of net assets are identifiable assets, liabilities and contingent liabilities of the
subsidiaries.

(h) Fair value of net assets

In order to calculate a realistic figure for goodwill, it is necessary to determine the fair
values of the assets and liabilities of the subsidiary company when preparing
consolidated accounts. Fair values need not be accounted for in the books of the
subsidiary company and used for the purpose of its legal entity based accounts, but
they should be used for consolidation purposes.

The fair value of an asset and a liability is defined as the amount for which an asset
could be exchanged or a liability settled between knowledgeable, willing parties in an
arm’s length (IFRS 3). If additional evidence of the fair values of acquired assets and
liabilities becomes available after the acquisition, the consolidated financial
statements should be adjusted to reflect this development.

(i) Non controlling interest (Formerly called Minority interest)

The 2008 amendments to IAS 27 changed the term minority interest to a new phrase
called non-controlling interest. According to the Official Pronouncements of the
IASB as issued at 1 January 2009, “the change in terminology reflects the fact that the
owner of a minority interest in an entity might control that entity and, conversely, that
the owners of majority interest might not control the entity.” It is the view of the
IASB that “non-controlling interest” is a better description than “minority interest” of
the “interests of those owners who do not have a controlling interest in an entity.”

SAS 27 uses the new phrase instead of the outdated minority interest, and defines non
controlling interest as “the equity in a subsidiary not attributable, directly or
indirectly, to a parent.”

When the parent company owns less than 100% equity shares in the subsidiary, say
70%, the remaining 30% is attributable to the non-controlling interest (NCI). Non-
controlling interest shall be presented in the consolidated balance sheet within equity;
separately from the parent shareholders’ fund. Minority interest in the profit and loss
account of the group shall also be separately disclosed below the profit after tax.

(j) Attribution of profit or loss to non-controlling interest

SAS 27 requires an entity to attribute their share of comprehensive income to non-


controlling interest (NCI) even if this will result in the NCI having a deficit balance.

(k) Pre-acquisition and post-acquisition profits

The profits of a subsidiary company are distinguished between pre-acquisition and


post-acquisition for the purpose of preparing consolidated accounts.

143
Pre-acquisition reserves are the accumulated reserves earned by the subsidiary prior to
its acquisition by the parent company. They are credited to cost of control account as
part of the process required to arrive at goodwill arising on consolidation.

Post-acquisition reserves are the accumulated retained profits since the date of
acquisition. The proportion of these reserves earned by the parent company is credited
to the consolidated accounts. To the extent that post-acquisition profits earned by the
subsidiary are transferred to the parent company by w ay of dividends, the amount to
be aggregated when consolidation takes place will be reduced correspondingly.

(l) Other reserves of a subsidiary

Other reserves of a subsidiary may include share premium account, revaluation


surplus on fixed assets and other reserves. The principle of dividing them between
pre-acquisition and post-acquisition reserves will apply.

3.15 Consolidation Procedures under SAS 27

In its explanatory note, SAS 27 outlines the following consolidation procedures:

(a) Financial statements of the parent and its subsidiaries are combined on a line by line
basis by adding together like items of assets, liabilities, equity, income and expenses.

(b) The carrying amount of the parent’s investment in each subsidiary and the parent’s
portion of equity of each subsidiary are eliminated.

(c) Non-controlling interests in the profit or loss of the consolidated subsidiaries for the
reporting period are identified.

(d) Non-controlling interests in the net assets of consolidated entities are identified and
presented in the consolidated balance within equity, separately from the shareholders’
fund.

3.16 Disclosure Requirements of SAS 27

The disclosure requirements relating to group accounts include the following:

(a) The nature of the relationship between the parent and a subsidiary when the parent does
not own directly or indirectly through subsidiaries more than half of the voting power.

(b) The reasons why more than half of the voting power in the investee does not constitute
control.

(c) When there is a significant restriction on the ability of the subsidiaries to transfer funds to
the parent, the nature and significance of such restrictions must be disclosed.

(d) A list of investments in subsidiaries, jointly controlled entities and associates, including
the name and country of incorporation.

144
(e) Where separate financial statements are prepared by a jointly controlled entity or an
investor in an associate, the reason for preparing separate financial statements, the list of
significant investment and country of incorporation of the investee must be disclosed.

Self Assessment Exercises

1. Mama plc owns 80% of the equity of Broda plc. Sista plc owns 20% of Broda plc. In
relation to Mama plc, sista plc is considered as a/an _______

a) An associate
b) A fellow subsidiary
c) A parent company
d) A subsidiary not consolidated
e) A minority interest
.
2. Mama plc owns 80% of the equity of Broda plc. Sista plc owns 20% of Broda plc. In
relation to Mama plc, sista plc is considered as a/an _______

4.0 CONCLUSION

Knowledge of the theoretical background for consolidation of financial statements and the
regulatory documents is very necessary for the preparation and presentation of consolidated
financial statements.

5.0 SUMMARY

This unit explained the legal and regulatory framework in the presentation of group accounts
with particular reference to the detailed provisions of CAMA 2004 and SAS 27.

In the next unit, we shall discuss consolidated balance sheet.

6.0 TUTOR-MARKED ASSIGNMENT

1. State one main problem with group accounting.

2. List one of the grounds on which a subsidiary may be exempted from consolidation.

3. Enumerate the disclosure requirements of SAS 27.

4. Define a group of companies and state the regulatory documents for group accounts.

7.0 REFERENCES/FURTHER READINGS

Adapted from the ICAN Study Packs (2011)

145
UNIT TWO CONSOLIDATED BALANCE SHEET

CONTENTS

1.0 Introduction
2.0 Objectives
3.0 Main Content
3.1 Consolidation Procedures
3.2 Goodwill
3.3 Pre and Post-Acquisition Profits
3.4 Non-Controlling Interest
3.5 Fair Value Adjustments
3.6 Inter-Company Items
3.7 Acquisition of a Subsidiary during the Year
3.8 Piecemeal Acquisition
3.9 Fellow Subsidiaries
3.10 Vertical Group
3.11 Mixed Group
3.12 Rights Issue by a Subsidiary Company
4.0 Conclusion
5.0 Summary
6.0 Tutor-Marked Assignment
7.0 References/Further Readings

1.0 INTRODUCTION

In the last unit, we explained the legal and regulatory framework in the presentation of group
accounts with particular reference to the detailed provisions of CAMA 2004 and SAS 27.

In this unit, we shall discuss consolidated balance sheet.

2.0 OBJECTIVES

At the end of this unit, you should be able to:

 Apply the basic principles and procedures involved in balance sheet consolidation;
 Calculate goodwill, unrealized profit, fixed assets;
 Account for inter company items and revaluation reserves on fixed assets of subsidiaries.

3.0 MAIN CONTENT

3.1 Consolidation Procedures

The essence of consolidation procedures is the elimination of inter-company balances and the
aggregation of the remaining balances.

146
Illustration 14.1

The summarised balance sheet of Nwakanobi plc ad it subsidiary Ogbuefi plc as at


31december 2008 are as follows:
Nwakanobi plc Ogbuefi plc
N’000 N’000
Fixed assets 63,000 58,000
Investment in Ogbuefi plc 120,000 -
Current assets: stock 26,000 22,000
Debtors 22,000 20,000
Bank balance 35,000 30,000
266,000 130,000
Ordinary shares of N1.00 each
(Fully paid) 215,000 100,000
Retained profits 40,000 20,000
255,000 120,000
Current liability 11,000 10,000
266,000 130,000

Nwakanobi plc purchased the entire share capital of Ogbuefi plc for N120 million cash, at the
balance sheet date (31/12/08.
Prepare the Consolidated balance sheet schedule of plc and subsidiary at 31 December 2008.

Suggested Solution 14.1

STEP 1: Preparation of the Consolidation Schedule

Consolidated balance sheet schedule of Plc and Subsidiary


Nwakanobi Ogbuefi Consolidated
N’000 N’000 N’000
Fixed assets at book value 63,000+ 58,000= 121,000
Investments in ogbuefi plc 120,000 - -
Current assets: stock 26,000+ 22,000= 48,000
Debtors 22,000+ 20,000= 42,000
Bank balance 35,000+ 30,000= 65,000
266,000 130,000= 276,000

Ordinary share capital 215,000 100,000 215,000


Retained profits 40,000 20,000 40,000
255,000 - 255,000
Current liability 11,000+ 10,000= 21,000
266,000 130,000 276,000

STEP 2:
NWAKANOBI PLC
Consolidated Balance Sheet as at 31dec 2008
N’000 N’000
Fixed assets at book value 121,000
Current assets:
147
Stock 48,000
Debtors 42,000
Bank balance 65,000
155,000
Less current liabilities 21,000
Net current assets 134,000
255,000
Capital and reserves
Ordinary share capital at N1 each 215,000
Retained profits 40,000
255,000
Tutorial
The inter company balances are crossed out because they cancel on consolidation

3.2 Goodwill

Goodwill arises on consolidation when the price paid to acquire the subsidiary is greater than
the fair value of net assets acquired

Illustration 14.2

Bada plc acquired the entire share capital of Santos plc for N40million cash on 31 December
2008. The balance sheets of the two companies at that date were as follows:

Bada plc Santos plc


N’000 N’000
Fixed assets 160,000 16,000
Investment in santos plc 40,000 -
Current assets: 390,000 48,000
590,000 64,000

Share capital of N1.00 per share 200,000 20,000


Profit and loss a/c 60,000 10,000
Current liability 330,000 34,000
590,000 64,000

There is no significant difference between the book value and the fair value of santos plc’s
assets.

(a)Calculate goodwill
(b)Prepare the consolidated balance sheet of Bada plc at 31december 2008.

Suggested Solution 14.2


Step 1
N’000 N’000
(a) Goodwill on consolidation

Cost of investment 40,000


Share capital 20,000
Retained profits 10,000
148
30,000 x100% 30,000
Goodwill on consolidation 10,000

(b) Consolidated balance sheet as at 31dec.2003

Fixed assets
Tangible N(160+16) 176,000
Intangible assets - goodwill 10,000
186,000
Current assets N(390+48) 438,000
Less current liabilities N(330+34) 364,000
Net current assets 74000
260,000
Capital and reserves
Share capital 200,000
Retained profits 60,000
260,000

3.3 Pre-and Post-Acquisition Profits

3.3.1 Pre-Acquisition Profit

These are the profits which accrued to the former shareholders of the subsidiary company.
They are not available for distribution to the shareholders of the parent company; rather, they
are treated as part of the capitalized value of the business at acquisition.

The pre-acquisition profits could include retained profits, share premium and other capital
reserves at acquisition. Others are revaluation surplus; recovery of bad debts written off
before acquisition and income receivable from crystallization of contingent asset that relates
to pre-acquisition period.

3.3.2 Post-Acquisition Profit

The increase in the reserves of the subsidiary which arose after acquisition by the parent
company is post-acquisition reserves. This should be aggregated with the reserves of the
parent company to obtain the consolidated reserves.

Illustration 14.3

The balance sheet of Peter plc and Sifau plc as at 31dec 2008 were as follows:
Peter plc Sifau plc
N’000 N’000
Fixed assets 40,000 32,000
Investment at cost 76,000 -
Current assets: 60,000 48,000
176,000 60,000
Share capital
Ordinary shares of N1.00 per share 120,000 40,000
Accumulated reserves 32,000 16,000
152,000 56,000
149
Current liability 24,000 24,000
176,000 80,000

The entire share capital of Sifau plc was acquired when the accumulated reserves was
N12million.

You are required to prepare the consolidated balance sheet of peter group at 31dec 2008

Suggested Solution 14.3

STEP 1 prepare the consolidated schedule and compute goodwill and reserves
Equity of sifau plc Total Pre-acquisition Post-acquisition
100%
N’000 N’000 N’000
Ordinary share 40,000 40,000
capital
Accumulated 16,000 12,000 4,000
reserves
56,000 52,000 4,000
Cost of investment (76,000)
Goodwill 24,000
Accumulated
reserves of peter 32,000
Consolidated 36,000
reserves

STEP 2 Prepare the consolidated balance sheet by adding the figures of assets and liabilities
of the companies, except for the figures that have been calculated in the consolidation
schedule above.
PETER PLC
Consolidated balance sheet as at 31dec.2008
N’000 N’000
Fixed assets
Tangible 72,000
Intangible assets – goodwill(w1) 24,000
96,000
Current assets 108,000
Less current liabilities 48,000
Net current assets 60,000
156,000
Capital and reserves
Share capital of N1 each fully paid 120,000
Accumulated reserves(w1) 36,000
156,000

3.4 Non-Controlling Interest

We shall now proceed to a situation where the parent company does not acquire the entire
share capital of the subsidiary.

150
The non-controlling interest in the share capital and reserves of the subsidiary will be shown
distinct from the shareholders’ fund and other liabilities in the consolidated accounts.

Illustration 14.4

The facts are as in illustration 14.3 except that Peter plc acquired only 30million of the share
capital of Sifau plc.

Suggested Solution 14.4

STEP 1
Determine the percentage acquired through the group structure

Peter plc acquired 30,000 * 100% =75%


In sifau plc 40,000 1

STEP 2
Consolidation schedule
Equity of Sifau plc
Total Pre-acquisition Post-acquisition Non controlling
interest
N’000 N’000 N’000 N’000
share capital 40,000 30,000 10,000
Accumulated reserves 16,000 9,000(1) 3,000(2) 4,000(3)
56,000 39,000
Cost of investment (76,000)
Goodwill 37,000
Peter’s reserves 32,000
Consolidated reserves 35,000 ______
NCI 14,000

STEP 3
Prepare the consolidated Balance Sheet
PETER PLC
Consolidated balance sheet as at 31dec.2008
N’000 N’000
Fixed assets
Tangible 72,000
Intangible assets – goodwill 37,000
109,000
Current assets 108,000
Less current liabilities 48,000
Net current assets 60,000
169,000
Capital and reserves
120million ordinary shares of N1 fully paid 120,000
Accumulated reserves 35,000
155,000
Minority interest 14,000
151
169,000

(a)pre-acquisition profit = N12,000(as 9,000


given)x75%=
(b)post-acquisition profit= N (16,000- 3,000
12,000)x75%
(c)non controlling interest = N16,000x25%= 4,000
Total 16,000

3.5 Fair Value Adjustment

In calculating goodwill, fair values of the fixed assets are used rather than the book values.
The revaluation difference is entirely a pre-acquisition reserve; if it is a surplus, the fixed
assets account should be debited and the pre-acquisition reserve credited with the difference.
On the other hand, if it is a deficit, the pre-acquisition reserve would be debited and fixed
assets account credited.

The treatment recommended by SAS 26 is that both the group and non-controlling interest
(NCI) share of revaluation difference should be accounted for.

Illustration 14.5

The facts are same as above (14.4) except that Peter acquired the share capital of Sifau plc on
1 Jan 2004. Freehold property, which was not depreciated, with a book value of N18million
was estimated to have a fair value of N28million on 1january 2008. No adjustment has been
made in the books of sifau plc.

Prepare the consolidated balance sheet of peter group.

Suggested Solution 14.5

STEP 1: shareholding (as in 14.4 step 1)


STEP 2: prepare the consolidation schedule taking into consideration the effect of revaluation
reserves of sifau on goodwill.
Equity of sifau plc Total Pre-acquisition Post-acquisition NCI
N’000 N’000 N’000 N’000
share capital 40,000 30,000 10,000
Accumulated reserves 16,000 9,000 3,000 4,000
Revaluation reserves 10,000 7,500 2,500
66,000 46,500
Cost of investment 76,000
Goodwill 29,500
Peter’s reserves 32,000
Consolidated reserves 35,000 ______
Non –controlling 16,500
interest

152
STEP 3 – prepare the consolidated balance sheet:

PETER GROUP
CONSOLIDATED BALANCE SHEET AS AT 31 DECEMBER 2008
N’000 N’000
Fixed assets N(40,000+32,000+10,000) 82,000
Goodwill 29,500
11,500
Current assets 108,000
Less: current liabilities 48,000
Net current assets 60,000
171,500
Capital and reserves
Ordinary shares of N1 each fully paid 120,000
Accumulated reserves 35,000
155,000
Non controlling interest 16,500
171,500

3.5.1 Fair Value Adjustment and Depreciation

The enhanced depreciation on asset revaluation reserve is calculated from the date of
acquisition to the accounting date. The value obtained is debited to the profit and loss account
and credited to depreciation account.

Illustration 14.6

The facts are as in (14.5) except that the property is depreciated at 2% per annum. Calculate
the accumulated reserve and the fixed assets to be included in the consolidated balance sheet.

Suggested Solution 14.6

N’000
Accumulated reserves
Share of Sifau plc post- acquisition reserves (see 14.5) 3,000
Enhanced depreciation now written off 2/100 x N10,000 (200)
Add peter plc reserve 32,000
34,800
Fixed assets
As per 82,000
Less: enhanced depreciation on revaluation reserve 200
Consolidated amount 81,800

3.6 Inter-Company Items

3.6.1 Current Accounts

Inter-company transactions within a group are usually dealt with in current accounts
maintained by the parent company and its subsidiaries.

153
At the year-end, the balances in these accounts may not agree owing to the existence of goods
in transit and cash in transit.

Adjustments should be made for these items of differences, as follows:

(a) If the goods or cash are in transit between the parent company and the subsidiary, the
adjusting entry should be made in the balance sheet of the parent company, no matter the
direction of the transfer.
(b) If the items are in transit between fellow subsidiaries, the adjusting entry should be made
in the books of the company to which the items are in transit; that is, recipient company.

Illustration 14.7

At the year end, the current accounts in the books of Hoo plc and Sho plc show the following
balances; Hoo plc being the parent company.

Book of hoo plc- account with sho plc N68,000


Book of sho plc- account with hoo plc N59,000
The difference is due to goods in transit from sho plc to hoo plc.

Explain the accounting treatment of the goods in transit.

Suggested Solution 14.7

Step 1: Adjustment for items in transit N N


Dr Stock in transit 9,000
Cr Sho current account (in hoo balance sheet) 9,000

Step 2: cancel the current accounts which are now in agreement

Step 3: include the stock in transit as part of the current assets in the consolidated balance
sheet.

3.6.2 Inter-Company Debtors and Creditors

If current accounts are not maintained, inter-company indebtedness in the form of debtors and
creditors must be cancelled for the purpose of consolidated balance sheet.

3.6.3 Bank Balances

Bank overdraft in any of the group companies should not be offset against favourable bank
balances in the other group companies unless the banks have been given written authority to
make such offset.

3.6.4 Unrealized Profit on Stock

Companies within the group normally supply goods and services to other members of the
group at a profit to the supplying company in order not to prejudice the rights of the outside
shareholders of those companies.

154
To the extent to which such goods are unsold at the end of the year, there will be some
element of unrealized profit on the unsold stock, from the view point of the group as a whole.

Treatment: the element of the unrealized profits must be eliminated because a company
cannot make a profit by trading with itself. The following treatments are recommended:

(a) For a wholly owned subsidiary company, the unrealized profit can be adjusted in the
individual balance sheet of the parent company by

D r: Accumulated profits
Cr: Closing stock
In parent’s company balance sheet

OR

D r: Consolidated reserves
Cr: Consolidated closing stock

(b) For partly owned subsidiary, SAS 27 recommends that the whole of the unrealized
profit should be eliminated from the group’s profit and stock, respectively.

In practice, this is interpreted as follows:

(1) That the sales from the parent company to the subsidiary will produce profit in the parent
company’s book. Consequently, the related unrealized profit should be eliminated in full
from the group accounts as in (a) above.

(2) Sales from the subsidiary to the parent company will produce profit for the subsidiary.
The unrealized profit on it should be shared between the group and minority in the
proportion of their holdings.

Note:
(a) The unrealized profit may be given as a mark-up on cost or gross profit margin
(b) The statement of accounting policy on the treatment of unrealized profit on stock should
be stated in the consolidated account.

Illustration 14.8

Goods were invoiced by parent to subsidiary company at cost plus mark-up of 25%. At the
end of the year, included in the stock of the subsidiary was this inter-company sales of
N24,000 at invoiced price.

Calculate the unrealised profit on stock.

Suggested Solution 14.8

Price structure:
Cost 100%
Mark up 25%
Invoiced price 125%

155
Unrealised profit =25x N24,000
125
= N4,800

Illustration 14.9

The facts are as in 14.8 above except that the goods were invoiced at a gross profit margin of
25% to the subsidiary.

Suggested Solution 14.9

Invoiced price 100


Gross profit margin 25
75
Unrealised profit = 25 * 24,000
100 = 6,000

Illustration 14.10

Given below are the balance sheets of panama plc and silo plc.

Balance sheet as at 31december 2008


Panama plc silo plc
N’000 N’000
Net assets (other than stock) 88,000 64,000
Investment in silo plc 79,000
Stock 20,000 16,000
187,000 80,000
Ordinary share capital of N1 each 110,000 50,000
Revenue reserves 77,000 30,000
187,000 80,000

Panama plc acquired 40million ordinary shares in silo plc when the revenue reserve of silo
was N10million. During the year, silo made standard mark up of 50% on cost. At 31
December 2008, N12million of these goods remained in the stock of panama plc.

Prepare the consolidated balance sheet as at 31 dec 2008. It is the group policy to make
allowance for the group’s share and non controlling interest’s share in unrealised profit.

Suggested Solution 14.10

Step I: group structure


Panama in silo 40 = 80%
50
NCI = 20%
100%

Step II: (a) adjustment for unrealised profit on stock


Cost = 100
Mark-up= 50
Invoiced price=150
156
Unrealised profit = 50 X N12,000,000 = N4,000,000
150 1 N’000 N’000

(b) Dr. consolidated reserves (4000 X 80%) 3,200


Non- controlling interest (4000 X 20%) 800

Cr stock 4,000

Step III: prepare the consolidation schedule to calculate goodwill, consolidated revenue
reserves and minority interest.
Equity in silo plc Total Pre-acquisition Post-acquisition NCI
N’000 N’000 N’000 N’000
Ordinary shares 50,000 40,000 10,000
Revenue reserve 30,000 8,000 16,000 6,000
48,000
Cost of shares acquired 79,000
Goodwill 31,000
Panama’s reserve 77,000
Unrealised profit on (3,200) (800)
stock
Consolidated revenue
reserve 89,800 _____
Non controlling interest 15,200

Step IV: prepare the consolidated balance sheet.

Panama group
Consolidated balance sheet at 31december 2008
N’000
Goodwill 31,000
Net assets (other than stock) 152,000
Stock N(20,000+16,000-4,000) 32,000
215,000

Ordinary shares of N1 110,000


Revenue shares 89,800
199,800
Non controlling interest 15,200
215,000

Statement of Accounting Policy

Stock: Allowance has been made for the whole of the unrealized profit on stocks of which the
group and the non-controlling interest bear their own shares.

Illustration 14.11

The facts are as in (14.10) above except that the question was silent on the policy for
unrealised profit on stock.

157
Suggested Solution 14.11

Step 1 as in (14.10) above

Step 2 (a)as in (14.10) above


(b)journal N’000 N’000
Dr: consolidated reserves 4,000
Cr: stock 4,000

Step 3 post- acquisition profit and NCI would change


Post-acquisition NCI
N’000 N’000
Ordinary shares 10,000
Revenue reserve 16,000 6,000
Panama reserve 77,000
Unrealised profit in stock (4,000)
Consolidated reserve 89,000 _____
Non-controlling interest 16,000

Step 4 in the consolidated balance sheet; replace revenue reserve and non- controlling
interest with the amount obtained in step III.

Statement of Accounting Policy

Stock: allowance has been made by the group for the whole of the unrealised profit on stock

3.6.5 Inter-Company Sales of Fixed Assets

As with stock, adjustment should be made for unrealized profits. That is, the consolidated
reserve must be debited and the fixed asset account credited with the unrealized profit on the
assets transferred. The over-charge of depreciation arising from the unrealized profit must be
removed by applying the rate of depreciation on the unrealized profit.

Illustration 14.12

Olu plc, sold a plant with a net book value of N60,000 to Ayo plc for N90,000. The policy of
the group is to charge depreciation on plant at 10% on cost per annum.

Required: Calculate the amount to be included in the fixed asset account and depreciation
account and show the journal entries.

Suggested Solution 14.12 N

Unrealised profit N(90,000 – 60,000) 30,000


Less: over –charged depreciation (10%) 3,000
27,000

Journal
Dr Cr
N N
Depreciation account 3,000
158
Reserves accounts 27,000
Plant account 30,000
Being unrealised profit on sales of plants written off.

3.6.6 Preference Shares in Subsidiaries

The percentage of preference shares held by the parent company in the subsidiary does not
determine the holding company/subsidiary relationship because they are not voting shares.
The preference shares should be allocated between (that is, credited in) the cost of control
account and the non-controlling interests. Any difference between the cost and nominal value
of shares acquired will be reflected as goodwill on consolidation.

3.6.7 Loan Capital in Subsidiaries

Loan capital and debentures are irrelevant for the purpose of determining a parent
company/subsidiary relationship. Where the parent company holds debenture or loan stock in
the subsidiary, the nominal value held by it, shall be cancelled against the cost. Any
differences between the cost of loan and its nominal value will be reflected as goodwill on
consolidation. Discount is negative goodwill and premium is a positive goodwill.

The loan stock/debentures of subsidiaries held outside the group are disclosed in the
consolidated balance sheet as part of the long term liabilities.

Loan interest of subsidiaries

In order to determine the profits available for appropriation, all interests’ payable and
receivable must be recorded by the companies within the group in their own books of
account; before the results are allocated for the purpose of consolidation.

For consolidated balance sheet purposes, the inter company indebtedness on interest payable
and receivable will be cancelled out. The interest payable to holders outside the group will be
disclosed under current liabilities of the group.

In no circumstances should the nominal value of or accrued interest on loan capital held
outside the group be shown as part of the non-controlling interest.

Illustration 14.13

James plc acquired 96million N1ordinary shares of N1each, 20 milllion of N1preference


shares of N1each and N25million 10% debentures in flemming plc on 1january 2008.

Balance sheets as at 31 December 2008, were as follows:

James plc flemming plc


N’000 N’000
Investment in flemming plc:
96million ordinary shares at cost 130,000
20million preference shares at cost 21,000
N25million debentures at cost 23,600
Sundry net assets 385,400 360,000
560,000 360,000
159
Ordinary shares N1each 400,000 120,000
8% preference shares 0 80,000
Retained profits 160,000 60,000
10% debenture 0 100,000
560,000 360,000

James plc acquired its investment in flemming plc when the latter’s reserves amounted to
N24million. Provision is to be made for half-year interest on debenture. Dividends were
proposed on ordinary shares as follows:

James plc – 10%


Flemming plc- 6%

Half year dividend is to be provided on preference shares.

You are required to prepare the consolidated balance sheet of James group as at 31december
2008.

Suggested Solution 14.13

Step 1 percentage holdings of James plc in flemming plc share capital and debenture:

Ordinary shares preference shares debenture


Group 96 = 80% 20 =25% 25 = 25%
120 80 100

NCI/liabilities 20% 75% 75%

Step 2 calculations of adjusted profits


James plc flemming plc
N’000 N’000
As per draft balance sheet 160,000 60,000
Interest on debenture 0 (5,000)
Proposed dividend on ordinary shares (40,000) (7,200)
Preference dividend 0 (3,200)
Retained profit 120,000 44,600

Total group current liabilities


N’000 N’000 N’000
Interest on debenture 5,000(25:75) 1,250 3,750
Dividend on ordinary shares 7,200(80:20) 5,760 1,440
Preference dividend 3,200(25:75) 800 2,400

Step 3 Consolidated Balance sheet schedule

flemming plc Total Pre-acquisition Post- NCI


acquisition
N’000 N’000 N’000 N’000
Ordinary shares 120,000 96,000 24,000
Preference shares 80,000 20,000 60,000
Retained profit (step ii) 44,600 19,200 16,480 8,920
160
Net assets acquired 135,200
Cost of investments 151,000
Goodwill (15,800)
Discount on debenture 1,400
Consolidated goodwill (14,400)
Add James’ retained profit
(step ii) 127,810
Group retained profit 144,290 ______
Non controlling interest 92,920

Step 4 Cost of investments in flemming plc


N’000
In ordinary shares 130,000
In preference shares 21,000
151,000
Discount on debenture N(25,000- 23,600) 1,400

Step 5 Consolidated Balance Sheet as at 31 December 2008


N’000 N’000
Intangible assets- goodwill 14,400
Sundry net tangible assets 745,400
Less: current liabilities
Proposed dividend on:
Ordinary shares N(40,000+1,440) 41,440
Preference dividend 2,400
Interest payable 3,750
(47,590)
Tangible assets, less current liabilities 712,210
Financed by:
Ordinary share capital of N1 each 400,000
Retained profit 144,290
544,290
Non controlling interest 92,920
637,210
10% debenture 75,000
712,210

Treatment of intra-group dividends in the consolidated balance sheet

Where the parent company does not hold 100% of the equity share capital, only part of the
dividends paid or payable by the subsidiary will be received or receivable by the parent
company. These transactions in the individual accounts of the group members should be
adjusted for in the consolidated balance sheet depending on the following circumstances.

(a) Dividends are paid/payable out of the post-acquisition profits of the subsidiary and
(i) have been accounted for by the parent company
(ii) have not been accounted for by the parent company

(b) Dividends are paid/payable out of the pre-acquisition profits of the subsidiary and
(1) have been accounted for by the parent company
161
(2) have not been accounted for by the parent company

In the case of a (ii above), the parent company has credited its share of dividends received or
receivable to its individual accounts. The debtors of the parent Company will contain the
relevant amount receivable from the Subsidiary, if it is dividend receivable.

In this circumstance, the debtors’ account of the parent company offsets the proposed
dividend account of the subsidiary leaving the dividend payable to third parties. This
dividend payable to third parties is shown separately as part of the current liabilities.

In the case where the dividends have been paid, no further adjustments are required in the
accounts of the parent company.

Illustration 14.14

Kudi plc acquired 80% of the ordinary share capital of owo plc some years ago, when the
reserves of the latter was Treatment of intra-group dividends in the consolidated balance
sheet N60million. The balance sheets of the two companies at 31 December 2008, are given
below.
Kudi plc owo plc
Nm Nm
Investments in owo plc 220
Assets (excluding debtors) 280 320
Debtors 100 80
600 400

Ordinary share capital 300 200


Reserves 150 90
450 290
Current liabilities:
Creditors 80 70
Proposed dividends 70 40
600 400

Kudi plc has included the dividend receivable in its accounts.

Prepare the consolidated balance sheet of kudi plc and its subsidiary as at 31 December 2008

Suggested Solution 14.14

Step 1 determines the dividend receivable by kudi plc that has been included in its debtors
and reserves.
N’m
Dividend payable by owo plc 40
Receivable included in debtors (80% X 40m) (32)
Payable to outside parties 8

Step 2 Adjustment for debtors in the balance sheet


Debtors in kudi plc 100
Debtors in owo plc 80
Dividends receivable included in debtors (32)
162
Debtors consolidated 148

Step 3 consolidated balance sheet schedule.

Subsidiary pre-acquisitionpost-acquisition minority


N’m N’m N’m N’m
Ordinary shares 200 160 40
Reserves 90 48 24 18
208
Cost of investment 220
Goodwill 12
Add kudi plc reserves 150
Consolidated reserves 174 ____
Non-controlling interest 58

Step 4 consolidated balance sheet of kudi group as at 31 December 2008


N’m N’m
Goodwill 12
Assets (exclusive of debtors) 600
Debtors (step ii) 148
760
Current liabilities:
Creditors 150
Dividends payable:
Kudi plc shareholders 70
Minority shareholders (step 1) 8 (228)
532
Capital and reserves
Ordinary share capital N1 per share 300
Accumulated reserves 174
474
Non controlling interest 58
532

(ii) Where dividends are paid out of post-acquisition profits and the parent has not yet
recognised its own share of dividends, the financial statements of the parent would be
adjusted before proceeding with the consolidation.

The necessary adjustment in the above circumstance is to:


Dr Debtors
Cr reserves

ILLUSTRATION 14.15
The facts are as in illustration 14.14 except that kudi plc has not accounted for its share of
dividend receivable in owo plc.

SUGGESTED SOLUTION 14.15


Step I: adjustment for kudi reserves
N’m
As per draft balance sheet 150
Add dividend receivable from owo plc 32
163
182
Step II Debtors account

Kudi plc N (100+32) million 132


Owo plc 80
Dividends included in debtors (32)
180

Step III only the post-acquisition reserves would be affected in the consolidated schedule thus
Nm (24+182-12) = N 194m

Step IV consolidated balance sheet as at 31 December 2008


N’m
Net assets (excluding debtors) 600
Debtors 180
780
Current liabilities (228)
552
Ordinary shares 300
Reserves (step 111) 194
494
Non controlling interest 58
552

B. Dividend received by the parent from the pre-acquisition profit of the subsidiary is a
realization of part of the asset acquired in the subsidiary; hence this dividend must be
deducted from the cost of investment;

(i) If the dividend received by the parent has been credited to the reserves (debited in the
cash account), the following adjustment will be made.

Debit: reserves of the parent company


Credit: Cost of Investment.

Illustration 14.16

Given below are the balance sheets of P and S both public limited liability companies as at
31december 2008.
P S
N’m N’m
Fixed assets 800 500
Cost of investment in S 290 -
Current assets 184 125
Current liabilities:
Trade creditors (68) (85)
1,206 540

Ordinary share capital 722 250


Reserves 484 290
1,206 540

164
On 1st Jan 2008, P acquired 70% of the ordinary share capital of S. The reserve of S at this
date was 100 million naira. In March 2008, S paid a dividend of N50million from this profit.
P has credited its share of dividend to profit and loss account. No dividends have been paid
nor proposed on the profits for the year ended 31 December 2008.

You are required to prepare the consolidated balance sheet of P group as at 31 December
2008.

Suggested Solution 14.16

Step I adjust the cost of investment as follows


N’m
As per draft balance sheet 290
Less: dividends received from pre-acquisition profits 35
Adjusted cost of share 355

Pre-acquisition profit would be N’m (100-50) = N50m

Step II post acquisition profit of P


As per draft 484
Less: dividends received from pre-acquisition profit 35
449
Step III consolidation schedule

subsidiary Total Pre-acquisition Post- NCI


acquisition
N’m N’m N’m N’m
Ordinary shares 250 175 75
Reserves 290 35 168 87
210
Cost of investments(step 1) 225
Goodwill (45)
Add P reserves (step II) 449
Consolidated reserves 617 _____
Non controlling interest 162

Step IV consolidated balance sheet as at 31 December 2008

N’m N’m
Fixed assets (P+S) 1,300
Goodwill (step III) 45
Current assets (P+S) 309
Current liabilities (P+S) (153)
Net current assets 156
1,501

Ordinary share 722


Reserves (step III) 617

165
1,339
Non controlling interest (step III) 162
1,501

(ii) If dividends are proposed out of pre-acquisition profit of the subsidiary but the parent
had not accounted for its own share, the adjustment required is to:

Debit: debtors account


Credit: cost of investment account

3.7 Acquisition of a Subsidiary during the Year

When a parent company acquires a subsidiary during the year under review, it is necessary to
apportion the retained profit for the year between pre-acquisition and post-acquisition profit.
In order to apportion profit between these periods, income is deemed to accrue evenly during
the year.

The pre-acquisition profit so determined would be added to the accumulated profits brought
forward at the beginning of the period under review.

Illustration 14.17

Insight limited acquired all the ordinary share capital of Asa ltd on 1 march 2008. The profit
brought forward in the books of Asa ltd on 10 October 2007 was N288,000, while the loss for
the year ended 30 September 2008 was N600,000. Calculate the pre-acquisition profit of Asa
ltd for the purpose of preparing consolidated balance sheet at 30 September 2008. Enquiries
indicate that profit and loss accrued evenly throughout the year.

Suggested Solution 14.17

Step 1: divide the accounting period between pre-acquisition and post acquisition periods,
from 1 October 2007 to 1 march 2008, is 5months pre-acquisition and 1 march 2008 to 30
September 2008, is 7mths post-acquisition.

Step 2: determine the profit/loss for the year between pre and post acquisition period.
Pre-acquisition = 5x600,000
12
= N250,000 loss

Post acquisition = 7 * 600,000


12
= N350,000 loss

Step 3: determine the pre-acquisition profits or loss of Asa ltd


Accumulated profits on 1/10/2007 288,000
Pre-acquisition loss for the year (250,000)
Pre-acquisition loss of Asa ltd 38,000

166
3.8 Piecemeal Acquistion

It is possible that a parent company did not acquire the whole of the equity shares in a
subsidiary on the same date but that the shares are acquired in bits (piecemeal) at different
dates. The investing company may not become a parent company until the second or third
series of acquisition.

Approach:

(a) The intention of the parent company will be taken into account right at the first
acquisition, whether it intends to gain control later. The investing company does not gain
control until it has acquired 50% equity, as earlier stated.

(b) If each purchase is substantial, and it is the intention of the parent company to gain
ultimate control, the pre-acquisition reserves should be calculated by reference to the
proportion of shares purchased related to the balance on the reserve account at the date of
each purchase.

Acquisition of 20% of the equity capital of the company is regarded as substantial and it
is therefore presumed that the acquiring company w ill gain control.

(c) If the parent company does not intend to gain control, the pre-acquisition profit is
calculated where control is eventually gained. No post-acquisition profits would be
attributed to the group until control has been gained.

(d) Dividends received before control is gained would be credited to the investing company’s
profit and loss account as normal income.

Illustration 14.18

Balance sheet of Harold ltd and Sule ltd at 31 December 2008


Harold ltd sule ltd
N N
Net assets 645,000 500,000
Ordinary share capital of N1 per share 420,000 400,000
Retained profits 225,000 100,000
645,000 500,000

Note: the shares in Sule ltd were acquired in two stages by Harold ltd, 100,000 ordinary
shares at N1.25 per share were acquired on 1 Jan 2005, when the retained profits of sule ltd
totalled N25,000 and 200,000 ordinary shares at N1.75 per share were acquired on 15
February 2007 when the retained profits of Sule ltd totalled N75,000.

You are required to determine the:


(i) Non controlling interest
(ii) Goodwill on consolidation
(iii)Profit and loss account balances to be included in consolidated balance sheet

Assume (a) that the parent company intends to gain control from the first acquisition
(b) That the parent company did not intend to gain control initially

167
Suggested Solution 14.18

Assumption (a) consolidation schedule:


Total Pre-acquisition Post-acquisition NCI
N N N N N
Sule ltd 2005 2007
25% 50% 0
Ordinary shares 400,000 100,000 200,000 100,000
Retained profit 100,000 6,250 37,500 31,250 25,000
Net assets acquired 106,250 237,500
Cost of investment 125,000 350,000
Goodwill (18,750) (112,500) -
Transfer 18,750 (18,750) -
Consolidated goodwill 131,250 _______
Non-controlling
interest 125,000
Add: Harold retained
profit 225,000
Consolidated retained
profits 256,250

Step 1: since Harold did not intend to gain control initially, pre-acquisition profit for the
purpose of determining goodwill would not be computed until Harold plc acquired more than
50% holding.

I.e. 25%+50% = 75%

Step 2 prepare the consolidation schedule:


Sule ltd Pre-acquisition Post- NCI
75% acquisition
N N N N
Ordinary shares 400,000 300,000 100,000
Retained profit 100,000 56,250 18,750 25,000
Net assets acquired 356,250
Less: cost of investment 475,000
Goodwill 118,750 _______
Non controlling interests 125,000
Add: Harold retained profit 225,000
Consolidated retained profit 243,750

Note: the goodwill and retained profits under the two alternative methods differ.

3.9 Fellow Subsidiaries

A company may acquire majority equity share capital in more than one company such that
those other companies are its subsidiaries but are not one another’s subsidiaries.

The goodwill acquired from each subsidiary would be aggregated to a single figure for
consolidation.
168
Illustration 14.19

P ltd acquired 70% of the ordinary shares of S ltd two years ago for N250,000 when the
reserves of S ltd were N100,000. On the same day, P ltd acquired 80% of the ordinary shares
and 20% of the preference shares of S ltd and paid N380,000 for ordinary shares and N56,000
for preference shares. On this date, the balance on the reserve account of R ltd was N150,000.
The balance sheet of the three companies as at 31 December 2007 is given below:

P ltd S ltd R ltd


N ‘000 N ‘000 N ‘000
Net assets 246 350 800
Investment in S ltd at cost 250
Investment in R ltd at cost 436 _____ ____
932 350 800

Preference share capital 200 100 200


Ordinary share capital 380 120 400
Profit and loss account 352 130 200
932 350 800

You are required to prepare the consolidated balance sheet of P group as at 31 December
2007.

Suggested Solution 14.19

Step 1: prepare separate columns in the schedule for S ltd and R ltd.

Consolidation schedule
Subsidiaries Pre-acquisition Post-acquisition NCI
Total S ltd R ltd - -
S Ltd N ‘000 N ‘000 N ‘000 N ‘000 N ‘000
Preference shares 100 100
Ordinary shares 120 84 36
Profit and loss 130 70 21 39
Net assets acquired 154
Cost of investment (250)
Goodwill (96)

R Ltd
Preference shares 200 40 160
Ordinary shares 400 320 80
Profit and loss account 200 120 40 40
Net assets acquired 480
Cost of investment (436)
Negative goodwill 44

Transfer S Ltd goodwill (96)


Consolidated goodwill (52) ____
169
Non-controlling interest 455
Add: P profit 352
Consolidated profit &
loss 413

Step 2: consolidated balance sheet of P group as at 31 December, 2007

N ‘000
Net assets 1,396
Goodwill 52
1,448
Financed by
Ordinary share capital 380
Preference share capital 200
Profit and loss account 413
993
Non controlling interest 455
1,448

3.10 Vertical Group

A parent company may exercise indirect control over a subsidiary through a subsidiary on
which it exercises direct control. The subsidiary on which it exercises the indirect control is
called a sub-subsidiary.

Illustration 14.20

Cacao plc acquired 80% ordinary shares in Pod plc few years ago and Pod plc acquired 60%
of the ordinary shares of Cook plc the same year. Show the group structure:

Group structure
Cacao plc
80%
Pod plc
60%
Cook plc

Conclusion
Cacao plc exercises control over Pod plc
Pod plc exercises control over Cook plc
Therefore, Cacao exercises indirect control over Cook plc

Consolidation procedure
Any of these two methods can be adopted to consolidate the result of the group members
Two stages/indirect method
One stage/direct method

TWO STAGE/INDIRECT METHOD


(a) Under this, the sub-subsidiary will first be consolidated with the subsidiary. The goodwill
acquired by subsidiary in the sub-subsidiary will be calculated. The reserves of the
170
subsidiary will be added to the share of post-acquisition reserves of sub-subsidiary. This
amount would be cancelled through the pre-acquisition period, post-acquisition period
and non-controlling interest in stage ‘b’.

(b) The subsidiary and the parent company will then be consolidated. The goodwill acquired
by the parent in the subsidiary would be obtained. The goodwill calculated for sub-
subsidiary in ‘a’ above will be shared between pre-acquisition and non-controlling
interest in the ratio of ordinary shares held by the parent in the subsidiary.

THE ONE-STAGE METHOD

(a) Under this method, the effective percentage of the shares held by the parent company
and non-controlling interest in the sub-subsidiary will be calculated.

(i) To obtain the goodwill, post-acquisition reserve and non-controlling interest,


(these percentages will be applied into the share capital and reserves of the
sub-subsidiary).

(ii) To obtain the goodwill, the cost of shares acquired by the subsidiary in the
sub-subsidiary will be shared between the pre-acquisition and non-controlling
interest in the ratio of the shares held in the subsidiary by the parent company.

(b) The subsidiary will be consolidated in the group in the usual manner. The application
of the methods is now demonstrated with an illustration.

Illustration 14.21

The balance sheets of P, S, and R at 31/12/2007

P S R P S R
N ‘000 N ‘000 N ‘000 N ‘000 N ‘000 N ‘000

N1 ordinary shares 1,500 600 300 Net assets 1,400 714 420
Investment
Profit and loss a/c 600 390 120 at cost 660 276 ____
2,100 990 420 2,100 990 420

P acquired 80% of the ordinary share capital of S in year 2004, for N 660,000, when the
profit and loss account balance was N 120,000 and S acquired 60% of the ordinary share
capital of R in the year 2005, for N 186,000, when the profit and loss account balance was
N60,000.

You are required to prepare the consolidated balance sheet of P group as at 31 December
2007.

171
Suggested Solution 14.21

1st method
Step 1: group structure
Group NCI
80% P in S 80% 20%

60% S in R 60% 40%

Step 2: consolidate subsidiary with sub-subsidiary

Consolidation schedule
subsidiaries Pre-acquisition Post -acquisition NCI
R N ‘000 R 60% S 80% N ‘000 N ‘000
Ordinary shares 300 180 120
Profit and loss 120 36 36 48
216
Cost of shares (186)
Negative goodwill 30
Add S reserves 390 ___
426 168

Step 3: consolidate S with P


Consolidation schedule

Pre-acquisition Post -acquisition NCI


Subsidiaries N ‘000 R S
S = 80% N ‘000 N ‘000 N ‘000 N ‘000
Ordinary shares 600 480 120.0
Profit and loss (see step III) 426 96 244.8 85.2
576
Cost of shares acquired (660)
Goodwill (84)
Share of negative goodwill 80%:20% 24 6.0
Consolidated goodwill 60.0
Add P reserve 600.0
Consolidated reserve 844.8
Add minority interest in R 168.0
Non- controlling interest 379.2

2nd method

Step 1: group structure


P Group MI
80% P IN S 80% 20%
S
60% 9 IN S (indirect) 48% 52%
R

172
Note: even though the indirect holding of P in R is less than 51%, R remains a subsidiary of P
because S is a subsidiary of P and R is a subsidiary of S and P exercises indirect control over
R.

Step 2: prepare the consolidation schedule


consolidation schedule

Subsidiaries N ‘000 Pre-acquisition Post -acquisition NCI


R =48% N ‘000 N ‘000 N ‘000 N ‘000
Ordinary shares 300 144.0 156.0
Profit and loss 200 28.8 28.8 62.4
A = 80%
Ordinary shares 600 480.0 120.0
Profit loss 90 96.0 216.0 78.0
748.8
Cost of investment (step 3) (808.8) (37.2)
Goodwill 60.0
Add P reserve 600
Consolidated profit 844.8 ____
Non-controlling interest 379.2

Step 3:
(a) Cost of investment

Group MI
N ‘000 N ‘000 N ‘000
P IN S direct 660.0
Profit and loss a/c (80%:20%) 186 148.8 37.2
total 808.8 37.2

(b) Reconcile the cost of investment in the draft balance sheet to the one in the note

N ‘000 N ‘000
As per draft 660
P cost of investment 276
S cost of investment 936
As per note: N (660+186) 846
The difference is ordinary investment 90

Step 4: prepare the consolidated balance sheet

P Group
Consolidated balance sheet as at 31 December 2008
N ‘000
Net assets 2,574
Investment (step 3b) 90
Goodwill 60
2,724
173
Financed by:
Ordinary shares 1,500
Profit and loss account 844.8
2,344.8
Non controlling interest 379.2
2,724.0

3.11 Mixed Group

Direct and indirect shareholdings in sub-subsidiary.

We shall use the two methods to consolidate a group balance sheet where the parent company
owns shares directly by itself and indirectly through the subsidiary in the sub-subsidiaries.

Illustration 14.22

The balance sheets of P, S and R at 31 December 2008

P S R P S R
N N ‘000 N ‘000 N ‘000 N ‘000 N ‘000
‘000

N1 ordinary shares 1,500 600 300 Net assets 1,400 714 420
Investment
Profit and loss a/c 600 300 120 at cost 660 186 ___
2,100 900 420 2,100 990 420

Notes:
1. P acquired 80% of the ordinary share capital of S for N570,000 and 20% of the ordinary
share capital of R for N90,000, when the profit and loss account balances of S and R were
N120,000 and N60,000 respectively in year 2008.

2. S acquired 60% of the ordinary shares of R for N186,000 in 2006 when the profit and loss
account balance of R was N60,000.

You are required to prepare the consolidated balance sheet of P group as at 31 Dec 2008.

Suggested Solution 14.22

Step 1:
Group NCI
P in S direct 80% 20%
80% P in R direct 20% 20%
60% S in R 60%
Total 80% 20%

Step 2: determine R pre-acquisition profits to be off-set against cost of control account.

P in S year 2007
S in R year 2006
174
S had acquired shares in R before P acquired shares in S. P will not start to consolidate the
sub-subsidiary until year 2007. Therefore, the relevant pre-acquisition reserve of R in P group
is N60,000.

Step 3: prepare the consolidated schedule of group


First method
Consolidated schedule

Pre-acquisition Post-acquisition NCI


Subsidiary N S in R P in R P in S P S
‘000 60% 20% 80% N ‘000 N ‘000 N ‘000
R N ‘000 N ‘000 N ‘000
Ordinary shares 300 180 60 60.0
Profit and loss account 120 36 12 12 36 24.0
S
Ordinary shares 600 480 120.0
Profit and loss account 300 96 144 60.0
Transfer S post-acq. _____ _____ _____ _____ 28.8 (36) 7.2
216 72 576 184.8 271.2
Cost of acquisition 186 90 570
Goodwill 30 18 6
Share of S in R
Negative goodwill (30) 24 6
Transfer H in S (18)
goodwill
Consolidated negative
goodwill 12
Transfer of negative
goodwill (12) 12 _____
Non controlling interest 277.2
Add P’s profits 600.0
Consolidated profits 796.8

Tutorial notes

(a) The share capital of R was shared between P,S and non controlling interest in ration
20%:60% and 20% respectively.

(b) The profit and loss of R was shared as follows:

Pre-acquisition:
S in R = N60,000 x 60% = 36,000
P in S = N60,000 x 20% = 12,000

Post-acquisition:
P = N(120,000- 60,000) x 20% = 12,000
S = N(120,000 – 60,000) x 60% = 36,000

175
Non controlling interest
N120,000 x 20% = 24,000

(c) Since we are consolidating P group, S post-acquisition profits should be shared


between P and non-controlling interest in ratio 80% and 20%.

i.e. P= N36,000 x 80% = 28,800


S= N36,000 x 20% = 7,200
36,000

4. The negative goodwill of S in R must be shared between the group and non-
controlling interest in ratio 80% and 20%.

That is: to group= 80% x N30,000= 24,000


Non controlling interest= 20% x N30,000= 6,000
30,000
Method two
Using this direct method could be less complicated than the first indirect method.
Step 1: group structure

Group NCI
P IN S (direct) 80% 20%
P IN R (direct) 20%
P IN R(indirect)80% x 60% 48% ___
Total 68% 32%

Step 2:
consolidation schedule

Subsidiaries N ‘000 Pre-acquisition Post -acquisition NCI


R =68% N ‘000 N ‘000 N ‘000
Ordinary shares 300 204.0 96.0
Profit and loss 120 40.8 40.8 38.4
S = 80%
Ordinary shares 600 480.0 120.0
Profit loss 300 96.0 144.0 60.0
820.8
Cost of investment (step 3) (808.8) (37.2)
Negative Goodwill 12.0
Add P’s reserve 600.0
Consolidated profit 796.8 ____
Non-controlling interest 277.2

Step 3: cost of investment


Group Non controlling
interest
N ‘000 N ‘000 N ‘000
P IN S direct 570.0 -
176
P IN R-direct 90.0
P IN R-indirect (80%:20%) 186.0 148.8 37.2
Total 808.8 37.2

Step 4: reconcile the cost of investment in the note with the draft balance

Sheet figures N ‘000 N ‘000


P cost of investment 660
R cost of investment 186
Total 846
P cost of investment in S 570
P cost of investment in R 90
S cost of investment in R 186 (846)
P cost of investment in R NIL

Step 5:

P group
Consolidated balance sheet as at 31 December 2008

N ‘000
Net assets 2,574

Financed by:
Ordinary share capital 1,500.0
Profit and loss account 769.8
2,296.8
Non controlling interest 2,77.2
2,574.0

Tutorial notes:

(1) Steps 4 and 5 are common to both methods.

(2) The direct method appears to be easier for consolidating mixed groups and that is the
method usually adopted in solving examination questions.

3.12 Rights Issues by a Subsidiary Company

The parent company will take up its share of rights in its subsidiary company. The number of
shares will change but the percentage held by the parent company in relation to the total will
not change. The rights issue might be made at a premium. This share premium is regarded as
pre-acquisition from the parent’s point of view since the value has existed before the date of
the rights.

3.13 Bonus Issues by a Subsidiary Company

The treatment accorded to the issue of bonus shares by a subsidiary depends on whether it is
made from pre-acquisition profits or post-acquisition reserves.

177
(a) Bonus issues made out of pre-acquisition reserves

Where the necessary adjustments have not been made in the books, the necessary
adjustments should be as follows:

 Debit the subsidiary’s reserves and


 Credit the subsidiary’s share capital with the amount of scrip issue

The goodwill and consolidation reserves will be the same before and after the bonus
shares were made from pre-acquisition reserves.

(b) Bonus paid out of post-acquisition reserves

Where the bonus is paid from capital reserves, no adjustment is needed for group
account purpose. However, if the bonus is paid out of revenue reserves, group
distributable reserves will be affected. The post-acquisition reserves would reduce by
the amount of bonus issue while the ordinary share capital will increase by
corresponding amount.

Self Assessment Exercises

1. P owns 60% of S and 25% of R. S owns 35% of R. R is a subsidiary of ______


2. What do you understand by the term consolidated balance sheet.

4.0 CONCLUSION

There are a lot of intricacies associated with balance sheet consolidation and as such, it is
necessary that we know to apply the basic principles and procedures involved in balance
sheet consolidation.

5.0 SUMMARY

This unit treated in-depth the mechanics of consolidating balance sheets in business
combinations, highlighting items that should not appear in the consolidated balance sheet and
explaining the adjustments required to eliminate them.

In this next unit, we shall discuss consolidated profit and loss account.

6.0 TUTOR-MARKED ASSIGNMENT

1. A subsidiary’s fixed assets were re-valued at a surplus on the date it was acquired by
the parent company. What will be the effect of this surplus on pre-acquisition profits
and post-acquisition profits of the subsidiary?

2. Judith plc acquired 85% of the six million N1 ordinary shares of Tolu plc on 30th June
2008 for N7.2million. Tolu plc paid a dividend of 10% from a profit of N3million for
the year ended 30 September 2008.

7.0 REFERENCES/FURTHER READINGS

Adapted from the ICAN Study Packs (2011)


178
UNIT THREE CONSOLIDATED PROFIT AND LOSS ACCOUNT

CONTENTS

1.0 Introduction
2.0 Objectives
3.0 Main Content
3.1 Consolidation Procedures
3.2 Format of the Consolidated Profit and Loss Account
3.3 Cancellation of Intra-Group Transaction and Non-Controlling Interest
3.4 Ownership of less than 100% Equity Interest in a Subsidiary
3.5 Intra-Group Trading
3.6 Transfer of Fixed Assets between Group Companies
3.7 Intra-Group Interests on Loan
3.8 Dividend on Preference Shares in the Subsidiary and Non-Controlling Interest
3.9 Acquisition of a Subsidiary during the Year
3.10 Assets Impairment
3.11 Extra-Ordinary Items
3.12 Profit and Loss Account of Vertical Group
4.0 Conclusion
5.0 Summary
6.0 Tutor-Marked Assignment
7.0 References/Further Readings

1.0 INTRODUCTION

In the last unit, we treated in-depth the mechanics of consolidating balance sheets in business
combinations, highlighting items that should not appear in the consolidated balance sheet and
explaining the adjustments required to eliminate them.

In this unit, we shall discuss consolidated profit and loss account.

2.0 OBJECTIVES

At the end of this unit, you should be able to:

 Explain the procedures involved in the consolidation of the profit and loss account of a
parent company and its subsidiaries.

 Eliminate inter-company sales and unrealised profits on consolidation

 Adjust for the effect of inter-company dividends and interest on loan and account for non-
controlling interest.

3.0 MAIN CONTENT

3.1 Consolidation Procedures

A consolidated profit and loss account is prepared by adding together the results of trading in
the year of the parent company and its subsidiaries after making adjustments that are
necessary to exclude inter-company items.
179
The law exempts the parent company from presenting its own profit and loss account together
with the group profit and loss account provided the consolidated profit and loss account
contains a note stating how much of the consolidated profit is dealt with in the accounts of
the parent company.

3.2 Format of the Consolidated Profit and Loss Account

In general, the format of the consolidated profit and loss account is the same as the individual
company accounts.

The consolidated profit and loss account for the year is divided into the following parts:

(1) Turnover less cost of sales of companies in the group after excluding inter-company
sales and purchases.

(2) The operating expenses of the companies in the group. Unrealized profit on group
sales still held in stock and fixed assets should be eliminated.

(3) Profit (or loss) on ordinary activities before tax for the year by companies in the
group.

(4) Taxation on ordinary activities for the year by companies in the group.

(5) Non-controlling interest, where the parent company did not acquire 100% equity
interest in the subsidiary.

(6) Extra-ordinary items, only the group share less the related tax should be consolidated.

(7) Appropriation of profits: This includes dividends of the parent company only and
transfer to reserves.

(8) Retained profit brought forward: only the post-acquisition profits of the subsidiary
should be consolidated with the profit of the parent company.

(9) Retained profit carried forward: This is the addition of the retained profit for the year
and the retained profits brought forward.

3.2.1 Format

Consolidated profit and loss account for the year ended 31 December, 2007

Turnover X
Cost of sales (X)
Gross profit X
Distribution cost (X)
Administration costs /and any impairment loss (X)
Profit from main business X
Other operating income X
Other interest receivable and similar income X
Interest payable and similar charges (X)
Profit on ordinary activities before tax X
180
Taxation (X)
Profit on ordinary activities after tax X
Non-controlling interest (X)
Profit before extra ordinary items attributable to group members X
Extra ordinary profit / (loss) X
Profit/(Loss) for the year X
Appropriations: (X)
Retained profits for the year X
Retained profits brought forward X
Retained profits carried forward X

Notes:
i. Of the group profit for the financial year, Nx has been dealt with in the accounts of
the parent company.
ii. Profit on ordinary activities before taxation is stated after charging the following:
N
Depreciation on fixed assets x
Auditors’ remuneration and fees x
Directors’ emoluments x

iii. The figures for extra-ordinary items and tax thereon are made up of all the parent
company’s extra-ordinary items and the group share of the subsidiaries extra-ordinary
amounts.

iv. Movement on Reserves


The group the parent company
N N
Retained profit b/f x x
Retained profit for the year x x
Retained profit c/f x x

Illustration 15.1

The draft profit and loss accounts of Joe plc and Abe plc for the year ended 31 December
2008 were as follows:
Joe plc Abe plc
N ‘000 N ‘000
Sales revenue 12,000 8,000
Cost of sales (5,000) (3,000)
Gross profit 7,000 5,000
Operating expenses (2,250) (1,450)
Profit before tax 4,750 3,550
Taxation (1,000) (800)
Profit after tax 3,750 2,750
Retained profit b/f 7,000 3,750
Retained profit c/f 10,750 6,500

Joe plc acquired the entire ordinary share capital of Abe plc when Abe plc was incorporated.
Prepare the consolidated profit and loss a/c for the year ended 31 December 2008.

181
Suggested Solution 15.1

Since it is a 100% acquisition, there is no inter-company transactions, simply add similar


items in the profit and loss of parent and subsidiary company.

Consolidated Profit and Loss Account


for the year ended 31 December 2008
N ‘000
Turnover 20,000
Cost of sales (8,000)
Gross profit 12,000
Operating expenses (3,700)
Profit before tax 8,300
Taxation (1,800)
Profit after tax 6,500
Retained profit b/f 10,750
Retained profit c/f 17,250

Movement of reserves
The group the parent company
N ‘000 N ‘000
Retained profit 1 Jan 2008 10,750 7,000
Retained profit for the year 6,500 3,750
Retained profit c/f 17,250 10,750

3.3 Cancellation of Intra-Group Transaction and Non-Controlling Interest

3.3.1 Inter-company dividends

Investment income receivable by the parent company would be cancelled against dividend
payable by the subsidiary.

Illustration 15.2

The facts are the same as in illustration 15.1 above, except both companies proposed
dividends
Joe plc Abe plc
N ‘000 N ‘000
Profit after tax (as in 15.1) 3,750 2,750
Proposed dividends (1,200) (1,000)
Retained profit for the year 2,550 1,750
Retained profit b/f 7,000 3,750
Retained profit c/f 9,550 5,500

Suggested Solution 15.2

Step 1: Investment income receivable by Joe


N ‘000 N ‘000
Journal entry
Dr. Inv. Income receivable
Account (100% x 1,000): 1,000
182
Cr. Profit and loss a/c of Joe 1,000

Step 2: Consolidation schedule


Joe plc Abe plc consolidation
N ‘000 N ‘000 N ‘000
Turnover 12,000 8,000 20,000
Cost of sales (5,000) (3,000) (8,000)
Gross profit 7,000 5,000 12,000
Operating expenses (2,250) (1,450) (3,700)
Profit before tax 4,750 3,550 8,300
Taxation (1,000) (800) (1,800)
Profit after tax 3,750 2,750 6,500
Adjustment for
Inter-company dividends 1,000 (1,000) _____
Profit attributable to
Group members 4,750 1,750 6,500
Proposed dividend (1,200) - (1,200)
Retained profit for the year 5,950 1,750 8,700
Retained profit b/f 7,000 3,750 10,750
Retained profit c/f 12,950 5,500 19,450

3.4 Ownership of less than 100% Equity Interest in a Subsidiary

It is necessary to consider a situation where the parent company does not own the entire
ordinary share capital in the subsidiary and the profits of the subsidiary brought forward at
the beginning of the period is not entirely post acquisition.

In this case, the non-controlling interest is deducted from profit after tax to arrive at the
profits attributable to group members and only the post-acquisition retained profit of the
subsidiary brought forward will be consolidated.

The following illustration will explain it better.

Illustration 15.3

Tolu plc and Ife plc


Profit and loss Account
for the year ended 31 December 2007

Tolu plc Ife plc


N ‘000 N ‘000
Turnover 50,000 14,500
Cost of sales 20,000 5,000
Gross profit 30,000 9,500
Admin expenses (8,000) (1,200)
22,000 8,300
Income from shares in
group company 3,600 ____
Profit before tax 25,600 8,300
Taxation (3,400) (600)
Profit after tax 22,000 7,700
183
Dividends (8,000) (4,500)
Retained profit for the year 14,200 3,200
Retained profit b/f 8,000 1,000
Retained profit c/f 22,200 4,200

Tolu plc acquired 80% of the ordinary share capital of Ife plc when the reserve of Ife plc was
N 600,000. You are required to prepare the consolidated profit and loss account of Tolu
group for the year ended 31 December 2007.

Suggested Solution 15.3

Step 1: reconcile the inter group dividend N ‘000


Dividend receivable by Tolu group as per draft 3,600
Should agree with N 4,500,000 x 80% 3,600

Step 2: Consolidation schedule


Tolu plc Ife plc consolidation
N ‘000 N ‘000 N ‘000
Turnover 50,000 14,500 64,500
Cost of sales (20,000) (5,000) (25,000)
Gross profit 30,000 9,500 39,500
Admin expenses (8,000) (1,200) (9,200)
Profit before tax 22,000 8,300 30,300
Taxation (3,400) (600) (4,000)
Profit after tax 18,600 7,700 26,300
Non controlling interest (20%)- (1,540) (1,540)
Inter-company dividend 3,600 (3,600) _____
Group profit for the year 22,200 2,560 24,760
Proposed dividends (8,000) - (8,000)
Retained profit for the year 14,200 2,560 16,760
Retained profit b/f 8,000 320 8,320
Retained profit c/f 22,200 2,880 25,080

Step 3: the retained profit brought forward for consolidation for Ife plc is arrived at as
follows:
N ‘000
Profit b/f as per draft 1,000
Pre-acquisition profit
(on date of acquisition) (600)
Post acquisition 400
Apply 80% to it 320

Step 4: Tolu group


Consolidated profit and loss account
for the year ended 31 December 2007
N ‘000
Turnover 64,500
Cost of sales (25,000)
Gross profit 39,500
Operating expenses (9,200)
184
Profit before tax 30,300
Taxation (4,000)
Profit after tax 26,300
Non-controlling interest (1,540)
Group profit for the year 24,760
Proposed dividends (8,000)
Retained profit for the year 16,760
Retained profit b/f 8,320
Retained profit c/f 25,080

Notes to the accounts


Movement of reserves
The group Tolu
N ‘000 N ‘000
Retained profit b/f 1 Jan 2007 8,320 8,000
Retained profit for the year 16,760 14,200
Retained profit c/f 31/12/2007 25,080 22,200

3.5 Intra-Group Trading

Intra group sales should be eliminated from turnover and cost of sales because the
consolidated profit and loss account figure for turnover and cost of sales should represent
only sales to and purchases from, companies outside the group.

The unrealized profit in goods not yet sold should also be excluded. The procedures are as
follows:

(a) Deduct the inter-company sales at selling price from both sales and cost of sales;

(b) Calculate the unrealized profit in such goods not yet sold (as explained under
consolidated balance sheet).

This amount should be deducted from profit and loss account and the stock in the balance
sheet.

3.5.1 Rules for removing Unrealized Profit

a. If the sales were made by the parent company, there would be no adjustment to non-
controlling interest;

b. If the unrealised profit originally arose in the subsidiary (that is, the sale is from the
subsidiary to the parent company) the non controlling interest should be adjusted for its
share in the unrealised profits;

c. Notwithstanding this second rule, all the unrealised profit should be eliminated from cost
of sales to determine the correct amount of gross profit earned by the group as if they are
trading as a single entity.

185
Illustration 15.4

The draft trading and profit and loss account of papa ltd and Suzie ltd for the year ended
31december 2007.
Papa ltd Suzie ltd
N ‘000 N ‘000
Turnover 5,000 20,000
Cost of sales (18,000) (8,000)
Gross profit 32,000 12,000
Operating expenses (10,000) (3,000)
Profit before tax 22,000 9,000
Taxation 6,000 1,500
Profit after tax 16,000 7,500

Additional information

a. Papa acquires 80% of the issued ordinary share capital of Suzie when the reserve of Suzie
was N 9,500,000.

b. In the year ended 31 December 2007, papa sold to Suzie goods costing N 3,040,000 for
N3,800,000.

c. At the end of the year, Suzie sold 60% of these goods.

You are required to prepare the consolidated profit and loss account of papa ltd, and its
subsidiary for the year ended 31 December 2007.

Suggested Solution 15.4

Step 1: calculate the unrealised profits on intra-group trading, still in stock

N ‘000
Sales revenue on intra-group sales 3,800
Cost of goods sold (3,040)
Total unrealised profit 760
Proportion not yet sold 100% - 60% = 40%
Unrealised profit N 760,000 x 40% 304

Step 2: eliminate inter-company sales at selling price from sales and cost of sales.

Add N 304,000 to cost of sales, (and deduct from the stock value in the balance sheet)

Step 3: Consolidation schedule

Papa ltd Suzie ltd adjustment consolidation


N ‘000 N ‘000 N ‘000 N ‘000
Turnover 5,000 20,000 (3,800) 66,200
Cost of sales (18,000) (8,000) 3,800 (22,200)
Unrealised profit (304) - - (304)
Gross profit 31,696 12,000 43,696
Operating expenses (10,000) (3,000) - (13,000)
186
Profit before tax 21,696 9,000 30,696
Taxation (6,000) (1,500) - (7,500)
Profit after tax 15,696 7,500 23,196
Non-contr.int x 20% - (1,500) (1,500)
Profit to group members 15,696 6,000 - 21,696

3.6 Transfer of Fixed Assets between Group Companies

(a) If the fixed assets are transferred at a value other than the net book value, the profit or
loss arising on the transfer is eliminated.

(b) The depreciation charge based on the cost of the asset to the group will be used to
reduce the amount of profit or loss to be eliminated.

Illustration 15.5

On 1 January 2008, parker ltd sold a plant to Saro ltd for N 165,000. The asset which
originally cost N 132,000 had a net book value of N 99,000 on the date of transfer. Both
companies depreciate plant at 20% on cost per annum and parker owns 60% of Saro. Show
the adjustments necessary at 31 December, 2008, the year-end of the group.

Suggested Solution 15.5


N ‘000
Unrealised profit on sale of plant 33,000
Enhanced depreciation N 33,000 x 20% (6,600)
Consolidated profit and loss account 26,400

The double entry is N ‘000 N ‘000


Dr. Profit on sale of plant 33,000
Cr. Depreciation account 6,600
Cr. Plant account 26,400

Another way to calculate the enhanced depreciation is:


N
20% x N 165,000 (transfer value) 33,000
20% x N 132,000 (cost) 26,400
Enhanced depreciation 6,600

The non controlling interest will be adjusted for its share of the reduction in depreciation,
because this was recorded in the subsidiary’s books.

N ‘000 N ‘000
The double entry is
Dr. Non controlling interest
(Profit and loss a/c) 40 % x N 6,600 2,640

Cr. Non controlling interest 2,640


(Balance sheet)

187
Illustration 15.6

The facts are as in illustration above except that Saro transferred the assets to parker. What
adjustments are required in the consolidated accounts?

Suggested Solution 15.6

The adjustments are as before:

That is to eliminate unrealised profit of N 33,000 and


Reduce the depreciation charge by N 6,600

However, the non controlling interest would be adjusted by N 13,200 (40% x 33,000) since
the unrealised profit is in the books of Saro.
The double entry is:
N N
Dr. Non controlling interest (balance sheet) 13,200
Cr. Non –controlling interest (income statement) 13,200

3.7 Intra-Group Interest on Loan

If the parent company owns a loan stock in the subsidiary, it will receive interest from such
subsidiary. Therefore, part of the total interest paid or payable by the subsidiary will be
treated as investment income in the parent company’s book.

On consolidation, both entries should be eliminated. Only the interest payable or receivable
from parties outside the group should be consolidated.

3.8 Dividend on Preference Shares in the Subsidiary and Non-Controlling Interest

The non-controlling interest in the profit and loss account will be calculated in two parts, viz:
Share of the non controlling interest in the preference dividend; plus Share of the non
controlling interest in the profits attributable to ordinary shareholders.

Illustration 15.7

Piper ltd acquired 75% of the ordinary share capital and 45% of the preference share capital
of Soso ltd many years ago.

Extract from the draft profit and loss account of Soso ltd for the year ended 31 December
2007:
N N
Profit after tax 250,000
Dividend payable
Preference 15,000
Ordinary 90,000
105,000 (105,000)
Retained profit 145,000

Compute the non controlling interest (NCI)

188
Suggested Solution 15.7
Total NCI
N N
Profit after tax (Soso ltd) 250,000
Less preference dividend 15,000(55%) 8,250
Available to ordinary shareholders 235,000(25%) 58,750
Total 67,000

3.9 Acquisition of a Subsidiary during the Year

The profit of the subsidiary from the beginning of the accounting period to the date of
acquisition is pre-acquisition profit. This profit will be excluded from consolidation.
There are two methods for accounting for acquisition during the year, to ensure that only
post-acquisition profits are consolidated
The two methods are:
(a) The part year method
(b) The whole year method.

For the purpose of consolidation, turnover is assumed to accrue evenly during the year.

3.9.1 Part Year Method

The subsidiary’s profit to be consolidated is the post acquisition profits only. The turnover,
cost of sales and other expenses will be divided between the pre-acquisition and post-
acquisition periods and only those of post-acquisition periods will be consolidated.

3.9.2 Whole Year Method

Under this method, the total profit for the year is included in the consolidation figures.
However, after the non controlling interest figure had been obtained, a deduction will be
made for pre-acquisition period. Similarly, the share of pre-acquisition dividends will be
excluded from consolidation.

Illustration 15.8

The draft profit and loss accounts of Hammer ltd and Nail ltd for the year ended 30 sept 2008
are as follows.
Hammer Nail
N ‘000 N ‘000
Turnover 5,720 2,400
Cost of sales (3,200) (1,200)
Gross profit 2,520 1,200
Operating expenses (1,440) (816)
Profit before tax 1,080 384
Tax (540) (192)
Profit after tax 540 192
Dividends declared (220) (45)
Retained profit for the year 320 147

189
Hammer acquired 75% of the ordinary share capital of nail on 1march 2008. Assume that
profits accrued evenly during the year. Prepare the consolidated profit and loss account for
the year ended 30sept 2008 using:

1) Part year method


2) Whole year method

Suggested Solution 15.8

Part year method

Step 1: the post acquisition period is from 1 march 2008 – 30 sept 2008= 7months
Step 2: consolidation schedule for profit and loss account

Hammer Nail (7/12) consolidation


N ‘000 N ‘000 N ‘000
Turnover 5,720 1,400 7,120
Cost of sales (3,200) (700) (3,900)
Gross profit 2,520 700 3,220
Operating expenses (1,440) (476) (1,916)
Profit before tax 1,080 224 1,304
Tax (540) (112) (652)
Profit after tax 540 112 652
Non controlling int (25% of N 112k) (28) (28)
Inter-company dividend (step 3) 49 (49) ____
Profit available to group members 589 35 624
Dividends declared (320) (320)
Retained profit for the year 269 35 304

Step 3: inter-company dividend N ‘000


Dividend declared by nail ltd 112
Attributable to group 75% x N 112,000 84
Less pre-acquisition 5/12 x 84,000 35
Post acquisition 49

Whole Year Method

Step 1: Consolidation schedule

Hammer Nail consolidation


N ‘000 N ‘000 N ‘000
Turnover 5,720 2,400 8,100
Cost of sales (3,200) (1,200) (4,400)
Gross profit 2,520 1,200 3,720
Operating expenses (1,440) (816) (2,256)
Profit before tax 1,080 384 1,464
Tax (540) (192) (732)
Profit after tax 540 192 732
NCI (N 192,000 x 25%) - (48) (48)
Pre-acquisition profit for the yr (step 2) - (60) (60)
190
Inter-company dividend 49 (49) _____
Profit attributable to members 589 35 624
Dividends declared (320) - (320)
Retained profit for the year 269 35 304

Step 2: Pre-acquisition profits for the year


5/12 x 75% x N 192,000 = N 60,000

3.10 Assets Impairment

The goodwill on acquisition should not be amortized but any impairment loss should be
accounted for in the profit and loss account in the period in which the impairment occurred.

The cumulative amount of impairment loss at the beginning of the accounting period is
deducted from the subsidiary’s post-acquisition reserves brought forward.
The impairment loss recognized during the current accounting period is treated as operating
expenses.

Illustration 15.9

The draft profit and loss account for the year ended 30june 2008 of a group are as follows:
Henry ltd souza ltd
N ‘000 N ‘000
Turnover 518,200 58,560
Cost of sales (327,045) (36,892)
Gross profit 191,355 21,668
Operating expenses (51,912) (5,856)
Income from shares in souza 3,740 ______
Net Profit before tax 143,183 15,812
Tax (67,485) (7,612)
Net Profit after tax 75,698 8,200
Dividends proposed 48,000 4,675
Retained profit for the year 27,698 3,525
Retained profit at 1 July 2003 88,147 16,983
Retained profit c/f 115,845 20,508

Additional information:
a) Henry bought 80% of the ordinary shares of souza ltd, three years ago when that
company’s reserves amounted to N 12,292,000. Goodwill of N 12,000,000 arose on the
acquisition.

b) Total of impairment loss of N 7,200,000 had been written off goodwill since acquisition
of souza of which N 2,400,000 is recognised during the current year.

Prepare the consolidated profit and loss account for the year ended 30june 2008.

Suggested Solution 15.9

Step 1: reconcile the intra group dividends


N ‘000 N ‘000
Henry received 3,740 should agree with 80%x N 4,675 3,740
191
No adjustment is required.

Step 2: Consolidation schedule


Henry ltd Souza ltd adjusted consolidated
N ‘000 N ‘000 N ‘000 N ‘000
Turnover 518,400 58,560 576,960
Cost of sales (327,045) (36,892) (363,937)
Gross profit 191,355 21,668 213,023
Operating expenses (51,912) (5,856) (2,400) (60,168)
Net Profit before tax 139,443 15,812 (2,400) 152,855
Tax (67,485) (7,612) (75,097)
Net Profit after tax 71,958 8,200 (2,400) 77,758
Non controlling interest (20%) - (1,640) (1,640)
Profit available to group members 71,958 6,500 76,118

Step 3: calculate the reserves of group brought forward

N ‘000 N ‘000
Henry ltd 88,147
Souza N (16,982-12,292) x 80% 3,752
91,899
Less: impairment loss (note 1) 4,800
87,099

Step 4: prepare the consolidated profit and loss account

Henry ltd and its Subsidiary


Consolidated Profit and Loss Account
for the year ended 30 June 2008
N ‘000
Turnover 576,960
Cost of sales (363,937)
Gross profit 213,023
Operating expenses (60,168)
Profit before tax 152,855
Taxation (75,097)
Profit after tax 77,758
Non-controlling interest (1,640)
Net profit after tax attributable 76,118
To group members
Proposed dividends (48,000)
Retained profit for the year 28,118
Retained profit b/f (87,099)
Retained profit c/f 115,217

Movement of reserves
N ‘000
At July 2007 87,099
Retained profit for the year 28,118
At 30 June 2008 115,217

192
Tutorial
N ‘000
a) Total impairment loss written off 7,200
Charged to profit in current year 2,400
Adjusted on reserve brought forward 4,800

b) The amount of the group profit for the year dealt with in the account of Henry ltd can be
obtained as follows:

Henry’s net profit before tax 139,449


Inter-company dividend receivable N (4675 x 80%) 3,740
Impairment loss (current year) (2,400)
140,783
Taxation (67,485)
Profit dealt with in Henry’s account 73,298

3.11 Extra-Ordinary Items

The proportion of the group’s share of the subsidiary’s extra-ordinary item should be
aggregated with that of the parent company for consolidation. The extra-ordinary loss or
profit is included after the profit in ordinary activities attributable to group members, less the
related tax.

3.12 Profit and Loss Account of Vertical Group

The principles for deriving the profit and loss of a vertical group can be understood as
follows:

 The post-acquisition profits of the sub-subsidiary will first be consolidated with the
subsidiary

 The aggregate of the post-acquisition profits of the subsidiary and sub-subsidiary will
then be consolidated with the parent company’s result

 All other items will be adjusted as explained before, that is, where the parent has only one
subsidiary

Illustration 15.10

The following information is given on port ltd, sea ltd and tea ltd for the year ended 31
December 2007:

Port ltd sea ltd tea ltd


N ‘000 N ‘000 N ‘000
Operating profit 1,995 1,030 775
Investment income 35 20 _____
Profit before tax 2,030 1,050 775
Taxation (750) (500) (250)
Profit after tax 1,280 550 525

Dividend paid:
193
Ordinary (100) (50) (25)
Preference (50) (25) (25)
1,130 475 475
Retained profit 1/1/07 2,400 800 650
Retained profit 31/12/07 3,530 1,275 1,125

(a) Port ltd acquired 60% of the ordinary share capital of sea ltd on 31 Dec. 2003 when the
profit and loss account balance of sea ltd was N 300,000.

(b) Sea ltd acquired 80% of the ordinary share capital of tea ltd in 2006, when the profit and
loss account balance of tea ltd was N350,000.

Required: prepare consolidated profit and loss of port ltd and its subsidiaries for the year
ended 31dec 2007.

Suggested Solution 15.10

Step 1: group structure


Port ltd
60%
Sea ltd
80%
Tea ltd

Step 2: reconcile the intra-group dividends


N ‘000 N ‘000
Investment income to port 35
Investment income to sea 20
55
Should agree with
Dividend received by port for sea 60% x N 50 30
Dividend received by sea for tea 80% x N 25 20 50
Investment income to be consolidated 5

Step 3: calculate the post acquisition profit brought forward:

Sea ltd tea ltd


N ‘000 N ‘000
Balance b/f 800 650
Balance at acquisition 300 350
Post-acquisition 500 300
Add 80% of tea post acq. 240
740

Therefore to be consolidated is: N ‘000


60% x N 740,000= 444
Add reserve of port plc 2,400
Consolidated reserves 2,844

Step 4: prepare the consolidation schedule


Port ltdsea ltd tea ltd consolidation NCI
194
N ‘000 N ‘000 N ‘000 N ‘000 N ‘000
Operating profit 1,995 1,030 775 3,800
Investment income 5 5____
Profit before tax 2,000 1,030 775 3,805
Taxation (750) (500) (250) (1,500)
Profit after tax 1,250 530 525 2,305
Pref. dividend of
Subsidiaries:
Sea ltd (25) 25
Tea ltd (25) 25
Available to ord. Shares 505 500
NCI (Tea 20%) (100) 100
Post acq. Profit (tea) 400
Transfer to sea 400 (400)
Available to ord. shares 905
Non contr. Int 40% (362) 362
Total minority int. (512) 512
1,250 543 1,793

Step 5: Port ltd and its subsidiary


Consolidated profit and loss account
for the year ended 31 December 2007
N ‘000 N ‘000
Operating profit 3,800
Investment income 5____
Profit before tax 3,805
Taxation (1,500)
Profit after tax 2,305
Non-contr. Interest (512)
1,793
Dividend paid
Ordinary dividend 100
Preference dividend 50 (150)
Retained profit for the year 1,643
Retained profit b/f 2,844
Retained profit c/f 4,487

Tutorial

The retained profit c/f can be reconciled with the retained profit in the draft profit and loss
account as follows:

N ‘000
Post-acquisition profit of
Sea ltd in tea ltd N (1,125-350) x80% 620
Add sea ltd reserve 1,275
1,895

Post-acquisition of port ltd 957


In sea ltd (1,895-300) x60%
195
Add port reserves 3,530
4,487

Self Assessment Exercises

1. Intra group sales should be eliminated from ____ and ____

2. In a vertical group situation, the post-acquisition profits of the sub-subsidiary will be


consolidated with that of the ____

3. Unrealised profit in goods not yet sold in intra group trading should be ____

4.0 CONCLUSION

The principle for consolidation of profit and loss account is the same for consolidated balance
sheet. That is, the results of all the group companies should be presented in one profit and
loss account.

5.0 SUMMARY

This unit explained the procedures involved in the consolidation of the profit and loss account
of a parent company, and its subsidiaries, demonstrates how to eliminate inter-company sales
and unrealised profit on consolidation and also how to account for non controlling interest.

In the next unit, you will learn about the principles governing the accounts of associated
companies.

6.0 TUTOR-MARKED ASSIGNMENT

Try your hands again on all the ten illustrations in the Unit in order to have a good grasp of
the step by step procedure of treating consolidated transactions in the profit and loss account
of a parent company and its subsidiaries.

7.0 REFERENCES/FURTHER READINGS

Adapted from the ICAN Study Packs (2011)

196
UNIT FOUR ASSOCIATED COMPANIES

CONTENTS

1.0 Introduction
2.0 Objectives
3.0 Main Content
3.1 Accounting for Investment in Associated Companies
3.2 Significant Influence
3.3 Methods of Accounting for Associates
3.4 Transactions between the Investor and the Associate
3.5 Effect of Associate on Group Profits
4.0 Conclusion
5.0 Summary
6.0 Tutor-Marked Assignment
7.0 References/Further Readings

1.0 INTRODUCTION

The last unit explained the procedures involved in the consolidation of the profit and loss
account of a parent company, and its subsidiaries, demonstrates how to eliminate inter-
company sales and unrealised profit on consolidation and also how to account for non
controlling interest.

In this unit, you will learn about the principles governing the accounts of associated
companies.

2.0 OBJECTIVES

At the end of this unit, you should be able to:

 Explain the basic principles and philosophy of accounting for associated company;
 Distinguish and apply the equity and proportionate consolidation methods of accounting;
 Prepare financial statements for associated companies.

3.0 MAIN CONTENT

3.1 Accounting for Investment in Associated Companies

Accounting for investments in associates is governed by the provisions of CAMA 2004 and
the requirements of SAS 28.

3.1.1 Definitions

Associate: The Act describes an associate as a related company.

Schedule 2, part V, paragraph 68 of the Act describes a related company as any body
corporate in which the investor (company) holds, on a long term basis, the equity voting
rights for the purpose of securing a contribution to the investor’s own activities by exercise of
any control or influence arising from it.

197
The Act further states that in a related company, the investor is deemed to:

 Hold a qualifying capital interest in the body corporate.


 Exercise material influence in matter relating to dividends, commercial and financial
policy of the body corporate.
 Hold 20% or more of all the relevant shares held in that body corporate
 Hold the interest on a long term basis.

3.1.2 Investments in Associates

SAS 28 defines an associate as an entity, including unincorporated entities such as


partnership, over which the investor has significant influence and that is neither a subsidiary
nor an interest in a joint venture.

3.2 Significant Influence

Significant influence is the power to participate in the financial and operating policies of the
investee but not control or joint control over those policies. A holding of 20% or more of the
voting power is presumed to amount to significant influence. A voting of less than 20% will
not give significant influence, unless it can be clearly demonstrated that such an influence
exists.

3.2.1 Evidence of Significant Influence

Significant influence is usually evidenced in one or more of the following ways.

(a) Representations on the board of directors or equivalent governing body of the investee;
(b) Participation in policy making processes, including dividend decisions;
(c) Material transactions between the investor and the investee;
(d) Interchange of managerial personnel;
(e) Provision of essential technical information.

Whether or not a significant influence exists also depends on the distribution of


shareholdings. For instance where the distribution is highly dispersed, a holding of less than
20% may give significant influence whereas a majority holding by one investor may prevent
the other from exercising significant influence even if it holds more than 20% equity.

3.3 Methods of Accounting for Associates

The accounting method prescribed by SAS 28 is the equity method.

Under the equity method

(a) The investment in the associate is initially carried in the balance sheet at the historical
cost. Thereafter, it is stated at the investor’s share of the net assets of the associate.

(b) The investor’s share of the associate profits is recognized in the profit and loss
account.

198
3.3.1 Detailed Procedure of the Equity Method

(a) Balance sheet

The group’s interest in the associate is the aggregate of the:

(i) group’s share of the associate goodwill, plus


(ii) premium arising on acquisition of interest in the associate profit/loss; plus
iii) the groups share of the net assets of the associate, less
(iv) any discount arising from acquisition of interest.

The investment in the associate is disclosed separately as a non-current asset.

(b) Profit and loss account

(i) The investor recognizes its share of associated company’s profit before tax.

(ii) The investor discloses separately its share of associated company’s tax.

(iii) The investor recognizes its share of extra-ordinary items and retained profit

(iv) There is a limit to the amount of the losses that the investor will recognize. Once the
associate’s net assets have been reduced to a zero value, no further losses will be
recognized.

3.3.2 Other Considerations

Unrealised profits

Only the group share of the unrealized profit should be accounted for.

3.3.3 Balance Sheet date

The financial statements used to account for the associate should be drawn up to the
investor’s balance sheet date. The investor may not be able to effect a change in the year-end
of the associate because it does not exercise control over it. Therefore, w here the accounting
dates differ; the most recent accounts would have to be used, with disclosures of significant
transactions since that date.

3.3.4 Uniform Accounting Policies

The accounting policies of the associate should be harmonized with that of the investor. If it
is not possible, the facts should be disclosed.

3.3.5 Contingencies

The investor should disclose:

(a) Its share of the contingencies and capital commitments of an associate for which it is
also contingently liable; and

199
(b) Those contingencies that arise because the investor is separately liable for all the
liabilities of the associates.

3.4 Transactions between the Investor and the Associate

Since an associate is not consolidated, these inter-company transactions will not be cancelled
out.

(a) Loan between associate and investor

The loan should be disclosed separately in the balance sheet as investment in the
associate. Loans to and from the associated company should not be netted off.

(b) Receivables and payables arising between the associate and the investor

The receivable and payables should not be netted off. Rather they should be included
under respective current asset or liabilities. Such receivables and payables should be
disclosed separately, if material.

3.4.1 Other Disclosure Requirements

(a) A list and description of significant associates showing:

i. the proportion of the ownership interest; or


ii. the proportion of the voting interest.

(b) The method used to account for investment in each associate.

Illustration 16.1

Tafa plc acquired 25% of the ordinary share capital of Balo plc three years ago for
N1,440,000. At that date, the share capital and reserves of Balo plc amounted to N5,184,000.
On 31 dec 2008, Balo plc capital and reserves amounted to N8,640,000. The net tangible
assets in Balo plc are stated at their fair values.

Required:

State at what amount the investment in Balo plc will be shown in the consolidated balance
sheet of Tafa plc as on 31 december 2008.

Suggested Solution 16.1

Consolidated balance sheet (extracts) of Tafa plc as on 31 December 2008.


N
Fixed assets xx
Investments in Tafa plc (note 1) 2,304,000
Note 1
N
Investments in the net assets of the associate
(25% x N 8,640,000) 2,160,000
Goodwill (note 2) 144,000
200
2,304,000
Note 2 goodwill
Cost 1,440,000
Less: share of the net assets at acquisition
(N 5,184,000x25%) 1,296,000
Goodwill 144,000

Alternative method

Cost of investment 1,440,000


Share of post-acquisition profit
25%x (N 8,640,000 - N 5,184,000) 864,000
2,304,000

3.5 Effect of Associate on Group Profits

The group profits will be increased by the group share of the post-acquisition profits of the
associate.

Illustration 16.2

On 31/12/2008, Abu plc acquired 40% of the 2,000,000 ordinary share capital of N 1 each of
Barllett plc for N 1,700,000 when the reserves of the company stood at N 1,200,000. On the
same date, Abu plc acquired 60% of the ordinary share capital of Dan plc when the reserves
of Dan plc was N 2,000,000.

The profit and loss accounts of the three companies for the year ended 31 December 2008
were as follows:

Abu plc Dan plc Barllett plc


N ‘000 N ‘000 N ‘000
Profit before tax 10,400 5,400 4,000
Company income tax (4,200) (1,400) (1,400)
Profit after tax 6,200 4,000 2,600
Extra-ordinary loss after tax (1,600)
Proposed dividend (2,000) (800) (200)
Retained profit for the year 4,200 3,200 800
Retained profit b/f 3,000 2,400 2,000
Retained profit c/f 7,200 5,600 2,800

Required: prepare the profit and loss account of Abu plc and its subsidiary including the
group share of associated company.

Suggested Solution 16.2

Abu group consolidated profit and loss account for the year ended 31/12/08
N ‘000 N ‘000
Turnover xx
Group profit before tax (P+S) - 15,800
Group share of associate profit N 4,000 x 40% 1,600
Profit before tax 17,400
201
Taxation: group (P+S) 5,600 -
Associate (N 1,400+40%) 560 (6,160)
Profit after tax - 11,240
Non-controlling interest N 4,000+40% - (1,600)
Net profit for the period - 9,640
Extra ordinary loss N 1,600x40% - (640)
Net profit for the period - 9,000
Dividend proposed - (2,000)
Retained profit for the year - 7,000
Retained profit b/f (w2) - 3,560
Retained profit c/d - 10,560

Movement on reserves
Retained profit b/f 3,560
Retained profit for the year 7,000
Retained profit c/f 10,560

Statement of reserves for the year ended 31 December 2008


(Disclosing associate reserve separately)

Group Associate
N ‘000 N ‘000 N ‘000
Brought forward (w2) 3,240 320 3,560
Retained for the year (w3) 6,680 320 7,000
9,920 640 10,560

Workings

(a) Goodwill in associate N ‘000

Cost of shares acquired 1,700


Share of net assets 40% N (2,000+1,200) 1,280
Goodwill 420

(b) Retained profits brought forward

Group N 3,000 + 60% (N 2,400-2,000) 3,240


Associate 40% (N 2,000-1,200) 320
3,560
(c) Profit for the year

Retained profit N 4,200+ 60% N 3,200 6,120


Add dividend receivable
From Barllett 60% x N 800 480
From Dan 40% x N 200 80
6,680
Associate N 800x 40% 320

202
Tutorial notes

(a) The associate profit before tax is not aggregated with the group profit. It is disclosed
separately. The associate tax is also disclosed separately from the group tax.

(b) Extra ordinary items (losses in this case) are shown below profit after tax and
minority interest. The share of associates gains or losses should be disclosed
separately.

Though not compulsory, it helps to approach this question by preparing working schedule
first.
Abu plc Dan plc Consolidated Barllett
N ‘000 N ‘000 N ‘000 N ‘000
Profit before tax 10,400 5,400 15,800 4,000
Associated profit 40% 1,600 1,600
Profit before tax 10,400 5,400 17,400
Taxation (4,200) (1,400) (5,600)
Associate tax - - (560) (560)
Profit after tax 6,200 4,000 11,240 1,040
Non contr. Interest - (1,600) (1,600)
Extra ordinary loss (640) (640)
Profit for the period 6,200 2,400 9,000 400
Inter-company dividend
Group 60% 480 (480) - -
Associate 40% 80 (80)
Proposed dividend (2,000) - (2,000) -____
Retained profit for the year 4,760 1,920 7,000 320
Retained profit b/f 3,000 240 3,560 320
Retained profit c/f 7,760 2,160 10,560 640

The retained profit b/f for Abu plc is N 3,000,000

Self Assessment Exercises

What is the entity over which the investor has significant influence and is neither a
subsidiary/interest called ______

4.0 CONCLUSION

The unit highlights the difference between the equity method of accounting and proportional
consolidation and their applications.

5.0 SUMMARY

This unit deals with the basic principles and accounting for associated companies.

In the next unit, we will examine procedures and principles guiding disposal of subsidiaries.

6.0 TUTOR-MARKED ASSIGNMENT

What accounting approach is prescribed by SAS 28 for associates?


203
7.0 REFERENCES/FURTHER READINGS

Adapted from the ICAN Study Packs (2011)

204
UNIT FIVE DISPOSAL OF SUBSIDIARIES

CONTENTS

1.0 Introduction
2.0 Objectives
3.0 Main Content
3.1 Categories of Sales of Shares in Subsidiary
3.2 Accounting for Disposal of Subsidiaries
3.3 Effect of Sale on Disclosure
3.4 Capital Gains Tax (CGT)
3.5 Partial Disposal of Subsidiary
3.6 Treatment of Dividend on Disposal of a Subsidiary Company
3.7 Deemed Disposal
3.8 Loss of Control
4.0 Conclusion
5.0 Summary
6.0 Tutor-Marked Assignment
7.0 References/Further Readings

1.0 INTRODUCTION

The last unit dealt extensively with the basic principles and accounting for associated
companies.

In the next unit, we will examine procedures and principles guiding disposal of subsidiaries.

2.0 OBJECTIVES

At the end of this unit, you should be able to:

 Explain and apply the principles relating to group companies disposal;


 Calculate the gains or losses and treatment of goodwill on disposal;
 Prepare consolidated accounts after disposals, including full and partial disposals.

3.0 MAIN CONTENT

3.1 Categories of Sales of Shares in Subsidiary

There are different categories of sales of shares in a subsidiary. The transaction may involve
the selling of the total holding of the subsidiary; on the other hand, it may be partial sales.
Disposal of subsidiaries will give rise to special accounting problems mainly in the
accounting period in which the disposal occurs. The main objectives of accounting for the
disposal of investment in a subsidiary are to:

(a) Determine the gain/loss to the parent company on one hand and to the group on the other.
(b) Determine the effect of the sales on reserve and
(c) Determine the effect of the sales on the balance sheet items.

205
3.2 Accounting for Disposal of Subsidiaries

Whenever there is a material disposal there is a need to calculate the gain or loss on disposal
of investment. Gains or losses on sales result in capital gains or losses. However, different
treatments are required in the individual accounts of the parent company and in the group
accounts, as follows:

(a) In the accounts of the parent company


The carrying value of the investment will be matched with the sale proceeds of the
investment sold less any capital gain tax.

(b) In the consolidated accounts


(i) The difference between the sales proceeds and the parent company’s share of
the net asset of the subsidiary at the date of sale plus the goodwill on
consolidation to the extent that it has not been written off

(ii) The profit or loss obtained for the parent company’s account (as in (a)) less the
post acquisition profits no longer required.

Illustration 17.1

Sale of total shares in Subsidiary

Shu plc acquired the entire ordinary share capital of kako plc some years ago for N 792,000.
On that date, the net assets and reserves of kako plc were N 608,000 and N 1,000,000
respectively.

On 31 December 2008, the entire shares held were sold for N 2,740,000 when the net assets
of kako plc stood at N 1,912,000. There had been no change in the share capital of kako plc
since the acquisition.

(a) Compute the profit or loss on disposal to be recorded in the books of shu.

(b) Compute the profit or loss on disposal; assume that goodwill had been fully written
off due to impairment.

Suggested Solution 17.1

(a) Gain on sale


N ‘000 N ‘000
(i) Separate account of shu
Proceeds 2,740
Cost of shares sold (792)
Capital gain to shu 1,948

(ii) Gain to group


Proceeds 2,740
Less: net assets at disposal (100%x N 1,912) 1,912
Goodwill not yet written off (w1) 184 2,096
Capital gain to group 644

206
Alternative method

Gain to group could be obtained as follows:

Gain to shu 1,948


Less: post acquisition profit to date of disposal 1,304
Capital gain to group 644

(b) Goodwill had been fully written off

()i Gain to shu


Proceeds 2,740
Cost of shares sold (792)
Capital gain to shu 1,948

(ii) Gain to group


Proceeds 1,948
Less: post acquisition reserves to date of disposal 1,304
Goodwill not yet written off (w1) 184 1,120
Gain to group 828

Alternative method

N ‘000 N ‘000
Gain to shu 1,948
Less: post acquisition reserves to date of disposal 1,304
Goodwill written off (184) 1,120
Gain to group 828

Workings N ‘000

1. Goodwill on consolidation
Cost of shares 792
Net assets acquired 608
Goodwill 184

2. Since there is no change in the share capital of kako plc between the acquisition and
disposal dates, the difference between the net assets at the two dates must be post-
acquisition profit.

Post-Acquisition Profit N ‘000

Net asset at disposal date 1,912


Less: net asset at acquisition date 608
Post acquisition 1,304

207
3.3 Effect of Sale on Disclosure

The subsidiary sold may constitute a discontinuing operation and may have to be disclosed
separately on the face of the profit and loss accounts in accordance with IFRS 5-Non-current
assets held for sale and discontinued operations.

Illustration 17.2

Ade plc acquired 75% of the 200,000 N1 share capital of Olu plc on 1 January, 2005 for
N350,000 when the reserve of that company stood at N192,000 and sold the entire holding on
1 September 2008 for N1,024,000. Ade plc held the entire equity shares in another company.

Given below are the draft profit and loss account of Ade group (with its wholly owned
subsidiary) and Olu plc for the year ended 31 December 2008.

Ade group Olu plc


N ‘000 N ‘000
Turnover 645 400
Operating cost (241) (120)
Profit before tax 404 280
Taxation (162) (112)
Profit after tax 242 168
Dividend paid (100) -_____
Retained profit for the year 142 168
Brought forward 680 640
Carried forward 822 808

(a) Ade has not yet accounted for the disposal of Olu
(b) Dividends paid were after the disposal of shares

You are required to prepare the consolidated profit and loss account of Ade group and olu plc
for the year ended 31 December 2008 in accordance with IFRS 5, incorporating the gain on
disposal.

Step 1: compute the gain on sale


N ‘000 N ‘000
Proceed 1,024
Less cost of sale 350
Gain to Ade plc 674

Gain to Group

Sale proceed 1,024


Less: net asset at date of disposal
Ordinary shares 200
Profit to 1/1/08 640
From 1/1/08 – 31/12/08 (8/12 x N168) 112
952
Group share 75% x N952 714
Goodwill not yet written off (w1) 56 770
Gain to group 254
208
OR

Gain to Ade plc 674


Less: post acquisition profit to date of sale - -
At 1/1/08 N(640 – 192) 448 -
1/1/08 – 31/12/08 (8/12 x N168) 112 -
560
Group share 75% x N560 420
Gain to group 254

Workings

Goodwill on consolidation
Cost of shares - 350
-
Net Assets Acquired - -
Ordinary shares 200 -
Reserves 192 -
Group share 392 -
Group share 75% 294
Goodwill 56

Step 2: Ade plc consolidated profit and loss account for the year ended 31 December 2008
Continuing discontinuing total
Operations operations
N ‘000 N ‘000 N ‘000
Turnover (N400 x 8/12) 645 267 912
Operating costs (N120 x 8/12) (241) (80) (321)
Operating profit 404 187 591

Profit on disposal of discontinuing operation 254 254


Profit before tax 404 441 845
Taxation N112 x 8/12 (162) (75) (237)
Profit after tax 242 366 608
Non controlling interest (25% x N168 x 8/12) (28)
Profit for the year 580
Dividends - - (100)
Retained profit for the year - - 480

Note on the Financial Statements

Movement on reserves
Ade plc group
N ‘000 N ‘000
Brought forward (w1) 680 1,016
Retained for the year (w2) 816 480
Retained profit carried forward 1,496 1,496

209
Workings:

(a) Group retained profit b/f (N680+ (640-192)75% = N1,016


(b) Ade plc retained profit for the year = as per draft P&L 142
Add profit on sale of Olu plc in Ade’s book 674
Total 816

3.4 Capital Gains Tax (CGT)

Capital gain tax is obtained by applying the capital gain tax rate on the gain on disposal in the
parent company’s account. It should be noted however that in Nigeria, with effect from 1
January, 1996, shares of every description have been exempted from CGT. However, it is
included for in some of the worked examples for illustration.

3.5 Partial Disposal of Subsidiary

A partial disposal may give rise to three types of relationship between the parent company
and the subsidiary.

(1) The parent/subsidiary relationship may remain but with a reduced shareholding;

(2) The subsidiary may now become an associate;

(3) The parent may now own less than 20% of the equity share capital which is ordinary
investment.

3.5.1 Partial Disposal of a Subsidiary leaving a Subsidiary

The consolidated accounts would normally be prepared for the whole year. However, the
non-controlling interest share would increase by the proportion of the share sold from the
date of disposal.

Illustration 17.3

The facts are as in 17.2, except that Ade plc sold only 40,000 of the ordinary shares held in
Olu plc for N560,000. Capital gain tax is 20%.

Required:
(a) The group profit on disposal
(b) Consolidated profit and loss account for the year ended 31 December 2008.

Suggested Solution 17.3

Step 1: calculate the proportion of the shares sold and the remaining shares
Shares acquired originally 75%
Proportion of Olu plc shares sold 40/200 x 100% (20%)
Proportion remaining 55%

Step 2: calculate the goodwill on acquisition


N ‘000 N ‘000
Balance at 1/1/04 56.0
210
Part disposal: 20/75 of share owned (14.9)
41.1

Step 3: calculation of profit on disposal of shares in Olu plc


Sales proceeds 560.0
Net assets of Olu at disposal (17.2 step 1) 952.0
Proportion of shares sold at 20% x N952,000 190.4
Goodwill disposed 14.9
205.3
Group gain before capital gains tax 354.7
Capital gain tax at 20% of N466.7 (alt method) (93.3)
Group gain after tax 261.4

Alternative method
Sales proceeds 560.0
Cost of shares purchased 75% 350.0
Cost of shares sold 20/75 (93.3)
Gain to Olu plc before tax 466.7
Capital gain tax at 20% (93.3)
Gain to Ade plc 373.4
Less: post acquisition profit no
longer required 560.0
Proportion of shares sold 20% 112.0
Group gain 261.4

Step 4: we can now prepare the consolidated profit and loss account of Ade group
incorporating the result of Olu plc. Olu plc is not a discontinuing operation.

Ade group
Consolidated profit and loss account for the
Year ended 31 December 2008
N ‘000 N ‘000
Turnover (P+S) 1,045.0
Operating cost (P+S+GW amortised) (361.0)
Profit before tax 684.0
Profit on disposal of shares in Olu plc 261.4
945.4
Taxation (P+S) (274.0)
Profit after tax 671.4
Non controlling interest
8/12 x N168 x 25% 28.0
4/12 x N168 x 45% 25.2 (53.2)
Group profit after tax 618.2
Dividend paid (100.0)
Retained profit for the year 518.2
Retained profit b/f 1,016.2
Retained profit c/f 1,534.2

211
3.5.2 Disposal of Shares leaving an Associated Company

The following are the basic principles for accounting for disposal of shares leaving an
associate company.

(a) The relevant profits of the subsidiary for part of the year before the sale, subject to
deduction of any non-controlling interest must be consolidated.

(b) For the period after acquisition, w e must include the appropriate portion of the profits of
the associated company using the equity method of accounting.

(c) In the consolidated balance sheet at the year end, the investment in the associated
company will appear at its cost, less any goodwill written off, plus the appropriate post-
acquisition profits of that associated company.

Illustration 17.4

The facts are same in 17.3 except that Ade sold 60,000 shares in Olu plc for N840,000.

Suggested Solution 17.4

Step 1: calculate the proportion of the shares sold and the remaining shares.

Percentage shares acquired 75%


Proportion of shares sold 60/200 x 100% 30%
Proportion remaining 45%

Step 2: calculate the balance of goodwill on disposal N’000


Bal at 1/1/04 56.0
Balance on disposal (22.4)
Balance on disposal 33.6

Step 3: calculate the profit or loss on disposal of investment


N ‘000 N ‘000
Sale proceeds 840.0
Net asset at disposal 952.0
Proportion of shares sold (30% x N952) 285.6
NBV of goodwill disposed off 22.4 308.0
Group gain before tax 532.0
Tax at 20% (see alternative) (106.4)
425.6
Alternative method N ‘000 N ‘000
Sales proceeds 840
Cost of shares purchased 350
Cost of shares sold (30/75 x N350) (140)
Gain to Olu before tax 700
Tax at 20% 140
Gain to Ade plc 560

Post acquisition profit no longer consolidated


Post acquisition profit 560
212
Proportion of shares sold (30% x N560) (168)
Group gain 392

Step 4: Ade group


Consolidated profit and loss account
For the year ended 31 December 2008
N ‘000 N ‘000
Turnover (N645+ (8/12 x N400)) 912.0
Operating cost (N241+(8/12 x 120)) (321.0)
591.0
Share of operating profit of Olu plc step 3 42.0
633.0
Profit on sales of shares in associates 392.0
Profit before tax 1,025
Taxation:
Group companies (N162+(8/12 x N112)) 236.7
Share of taxation associate N(112 x 4/12) 37.3
(274.0)
Profit after tax 751.0
Minority interest (25% x 8/12 x 168) (28.0)
Group profit 723.0
Proposed dividend (100.0)
Retained profit for the year 623.0
Retained profit b/f 1,016.0
Retained profit c/f 1,639.0

Working
Share of operating profit of associate = N(280x (45% x 4/12)= N42

3.5.3 Disposal leaving Ordinary/Trade Investment

The following principles give the disposal of subsidiaries leaving ordinary/trade investment.

(a) The consolidated profit and loss account must include the whole of the profits of the
subsidiary up to date of disposal subject to any minority interest together with the
profit or loss on disposal. Subsequently, credit will be taken in the investing company
for the dividend receivable.

(b) In the balance sheet the investment will appear at either its historical cost unless its
value had fallen permanently below cost or at a re-valued amount (SAS 13 and IAS
39).

Illustration 17.5

The facts are as in 17.3 except that Ade sold 60% of the shares held in Olu plc for
N1,680,000.

Suggested Solution 17.5

Step 1: calculate the balance of goodwill at disposal date


N ‘000
213
Bal at 1/1/04 56.0
Part disposal 60/75 (44.8)
11.2

Step 2: calculating the profit or loss on disposal of investment


N ‘000 N ‘000
Sales proceeds 1,680.0
Net assets at disposal (as before) 952.0
Proportion of shares sold 60% of N952 571.2
NBV of goodwill disposal 44.8 -
(616.0)
Group gain before tax 1,064.0
Taxation 20% (280.0)
784.0
Alternative method
N ‘000 N ‘000
Sales proceeds 1,680.0
Cost of shares purchased 350.0
Cost of shares sold 60/75 x N350 (280.0)
1,400.0
Taxation 20% (280.0)
Gain to Ade after tax 1,120.0
Post acquisition profit 560.0
Proportion of shares sold 60% (336.0)
Gain to group 784.0

Step 3: Ade group


Consolidated profit and loss account
For the year ended 31 December 2008
N ‘000
Turnover (as in 17.4) 912.0
Operating cost (361.0)
Operating profits 551.0
Profit on sale of shares in Olu plc 784.0
Profit before tax 1,335.0
Tax- Group Company only (236.7)
Profit after tax 1,098.3
Non controlling interest (25% x (8/12 x 168))(28.0)
Retained profit 1,070.3
Retained profit b/f as before 1,016.0
Retained profit c/f 2,086.3

3.6 Treatment of Dividend on Disposal of a Subsidiary Company

There are two approaches to the treatment of dividends. Each approach depends on whether
the dividend is paid before the date of disposal or paid/proposed after the date of disposal.

(a) If the dividend has been paid before the disposal, the full amount is deducted from the
net assets at the date of disposal.

214
(b) If the dividend is paid after the date of the disposal, the payment will not affect the net
asset at date of disposal. Therefore, the dividend should be ignored for the purpose of
determining net asset disposed.

3.7 Deemed Disposal

A deemed disposal arises where the interest of a group in a subsidiary company is reduced for
reasons other than direct sales of shares. Some of such instances are:

(a) Rights issue by the subsidiary company were not taken up by the parent.
(b) Scrip or bonus issue by the subsidiary is not taken up by the parent.
(c) Third parties in the subsidiary exercises option or warrants.
(d) The subsidiary issued voting shares to third parties.

The principles for the computation of the profit or loss on sale and treatment of the subsidiary
in year of the disposal are applicable to deemed disposal.

However, no change is made to the goodwill when a deemed disposal occurs because none of
the cost of acquisition has been realized in the form of actual sales.

Illustration 17.6

The profit and loss account of Gwuzo plc and its subsidiaries for the year ended 31 December
2007.
Gwuzo salim masca
N ‘000 N ‘000 N ‘000
Profit before tax 600,000 400,000 240,000
Taxation (280,000) (168,000) (63,000)
Profit after tax 320,000 232,000 177,000
Dividend paid 120,000 - -
Retained profit for the year 200,000 232,000 177,000

Gwuzo owned 80% of salim and 75% of masca since their incorporation. At 1 January 2007,
both subsidiaries have issued share capital of N300 million. On 30 April 2007, masca issued
N300 million ordinary shares to third parties for consideration of N300 million and its
reserves amounted to N226 million.

Prepare the consolidated income statement for the year ended 31 December 2007.

Suggested Solution 17.6

Step 1: calculate the profit or loss on disposal. Only the profit of the group can be calculated
in case of deemed disposal because the individual parent company has received no
consideration for the disposal.

Share of nets at disposal N ‘000 N ‘000


Share capital 300,000
Reserves b/f on 1/1/07 266,000
Reserves from 1/1/07 – 30/4/07
(4/12 x N177,000) 59,000
75%x 625,000 468,750
215
Share of net assets after disposal

Share capital 600,000


Reserves b/f 1/1/07 266,000
Reserves from 1/1/07 – 30/4/07 59,000
37.5%x 925,000 346,875
Loss on disposal 121,875

Note: When the share capital of masca plc was 300 million, gwuzo held 75% or 225 million.
Now that the share capital of masca has been increased to 600 million without a
corresponding increase in the shares held by gwuzo , the proportion held by gwuzo reduced
to:
225 x 100% = 37.5%
600

Step 2: Gwuzo group consolidated profit and loss account


for the year ended 31/12/07

N ‘000 N ‘000
Profit before tax (w+s+4/12 x 240) 1,080,000
Share of associates (8/12 x 37.5% x 240) 60,000
Loss on disposal of masca (121,875)
1,018,125
Tax (w+s+4/12 x 63) 469,000
Share of associates (8/12 x 37.5% x 63) 14,750 (484,750)
533,375
Non controlling interest:
Salim (20% x 232) 46,400
Masca (25% x 177 x 4/12) 14,750 (61,150)
Profit attributable to group members 472,225
Dividend paid (120,000)
Retained profit 352,225

3.8 Loss of Control

A parent loses control of a subsidiary when it no longer has the power to govern the financial
and operating policies of an investee so as to obtain benefits from its activities. A parent can
lose control of a subsidiary through sale of an ownership interest, or through other methods
such as when a subsidiary issues new voting shares to other parties. Control can also be lost
through some transactions and events that the parent is not involved in, for instance, when the
subsidiary is placed under the control of government, court, regulatory body, or administrator
in the event of bankruptcy.

SA S 27 prescribes the accounting procedures of a parent that loses control in a subsidiary.


Under SAS 27, if a parent loses control in a subsidiary, it:

(a) derecognises the assets (including any goodwill) and liabilities of the subsidiary at
their carrying amounts at the date when control is lost;

(b) derecognises the carrying amount of any non-controlling interests in the former
subsidiary at the date when control is lost;
216
(c) recognises:
(i) the fair value of the considerations received, if any, from the transaction, event
or circumstances that resulted in the loss of control; and

(ii) if the transaction that resulted in the loss of control involves a distribution of
shares of the subsidiary to owners in their capacity as owners, that
distribution;

(d) recognises any investment retained in the former subsidiary at its fair value at the date
when control is lost;

(e) reclassifies to profit or loss, or transfers directly to retained earnings if required in


accordance with other SASs, all amounts recognised in other comprehensive income
in relation to that subsidiary; and

(f) recognises any resulting difference as a gain or loss in profit or loss attributable to the
parent.

On loss of control of a subsidiary, any investment retained in the former subsidiary and any
amounts owed by or to the former subsidiary shall be accounted for in accordance with other
SASs from the date when control is lost.

This is a requirement of SAS 27, on consolidated and separate financial statements.

Illustration 17.7

On 12th February 20x9, Umah investment plc was wound up by a federal high court in
Nigeria for default in delivering statutory reports to the corporate affairs commission. Odiwe
plc had acquired 80% of the shares of umah investment plc several years ago.

The consolidated balance sheet of odiwe plc at 31 December 20x8 shows the following
summarised position.
Nm
Assets
Non current assets 11,350
Current assets 4,720
16,070
Equity and liabilities
Shareholders’ fund 8,000
Non-controlling interest 380
Total equity 8,380
Non current liabilities 4,800
Current liabilities 2,890
16,070

From the consolidation schedule and workings for the year ended 31 December 20x8, you
obtained the following figures.

(a) Goodwill on acquisition of Umah plc, N50million.


(b) Non controlling interest in the net assets of Umah plc.
(c) Other information concerning Umah plc.
217
(i) Non current assets at 31 December 20x8 N410m
(ii) Non current liabilities N330m
(iii)Current assets N320m
(iv) Current liabilities N280m
(v) Consolidated post acquisition reserves N106m

Required:
Prepare the summarised balance sheet of Odiwe plc after adjusting for loss of control in
accordance with SAS 27, on consolidated and separate financial statements.

Suggested Solution 17.7

Summarised consolidated balance sheet of


Odiwe plc at 31 December 20x8
Nm
Non current assets N(11,350-410-50) 10,890
Current assets N(4,720-320) 4,400
15,290
Shareholders fund N(8,000-106) 7,894
Non controlling interest N(380-64) 316
Total equity 8,210
Non –controlling interest 4,470
Current liabilities 2,610
Total equity and liabilities 15,290

Self Assessment Exercises

Where a total disposal of a subsidiary occurs, the group’s gain on disposal for the year ended
should be classified under the heading ______

(a) Discontinued operations


(b) Negative goodwill
(c) Positive goodwill
(d) Investment at market value
(e) Capital reserves

4.0 CONCLUSION

Under SAS 27, when the control of a subsidiary is lost, the parent derecognises the individual
assets, liabilities and equity including non controlling interests amount, previously recognised
in other comprehensive income. The investment retained in the former subsidiary is
recognised at fair value.

5.0 SUMMARY

This unit has dealt with how to account for the disposal.

In the next unit, we shall dwell on principles and procedures guiding group cash flow.

218
6.0 TUTOR-MARKED ASSIGNMENT

1. List an instance that is regarded as deemed disposal of shares in a subsidiary by a


parent company.

2. Investor company’s loans to the associate is disclosed separately as _____ in the


farmer’s balance sheet.

7.0 REFERENCES/FURTHER READINGS

Adapted from the ICAN Study Packs (2011)

219
UNIT SIX GROUP CASHFLOW

CONTENTS

1.0 Introduction
2.0 Objectives
3.0 Main Content
3.1 Preparation of Consolidated Cash Flow Statement
3.2 Subsidiaries with Non-Controlling Interests
3.3 Associated Companies
3.4 Joint Venture
3.5 Acquisition of Subsidiaries during the Accounting Period
3.6 Treatment of Dividend on Disposal of a Subsidiary Company
3.7 Deemed Disposal
3.8 Loss of Control
4.0 Conclusion
5.0 Summary
6.0 Tutor-Marked Assignment
7.0 References/Further Readings

1.0 INTRODUCTION

In the last unit, we dealt extensively with the basic principles and accounting for associated
companies.

In this unit, we shall dwell on principles and procedures guiding group cash flow.

2.0 OBJECTIVES

At the end of this unit, you should be able to:

 Prepare consolidated cash flow statements;


 Know how to account for cash flows involving associates in group cash flow statements;
 Account for acquisition and disposal of subsidiaries in group cash flow statements.

3.0 MAIN CONTENT

3.1 Preparation of Consolidated Cash Flow Statement

The group cash flows are analyzed under the same major headings as for a single company.
The statement will eliminate the cash flows that are internal to the group in the preparation of
consolidated cash flow statement. There are specific points to note in relation to the following
events as they affect the preparation of group cash flow statement:

(a) Subsidiaries with non-controlling interests;


(b) Associated companies;
(c) Joint ventures;
(d) Investments acquired during the accounting period.

3.2 Subsidiaries with Non-Controlling Interest

220
Dividends paid to minority shareholders are cash flows that are extended to the group and
will be shown as a cash outflow under ‘financing activities’.

Illustration 18.1

The following information has been extracted from the consolidated balance sheet of Ola plc
for the year ended 31 December:
2008 2007
Nm Nm
Dividend payable to minority shareholders 500 800
Non controlling interest in group net assets 3,900 3,450
Non controlling interest in consolidated
Profit after tax 600 1,150

Calculate the dividend paid to the minority shareholders.

Suggested Solution 18.1

Non controlling interest


Nm Nm
Dividends paid (bal fig) 450 bal b/d dividends payable 800
Bal c/d dividends payable 500 bal b/d non controlling int. 3,450
Bal c/d minority interest 3,900 share of profits in the year 600
4,850 4,850

3.3 Associated Companies

Associated companies are accounted for by the equity method; therefore, the associate should
be included in the group cash flow statement only to the extent of the actual cash flows
between the group and the associate.

The only instance when the cash flow of the group is affected by investments in associates is
when:

(a) Dividends are received out of the profits of the associate;


(b) Trading occurs between the group and the associate; or
(c) Change in investment is made in associate.

(a) Dividends
Dividends received from associates should be shown as separate inflow in the group
cash flow statement under `operating activities.

(b) Trading between group and associate


Trading between the group and associate will give rise to inter-company balances at
the balance sheet date. Therefore, when cash is paid or received in respect of inter-
company balances, the cash is included in the cash received from customers or in the
cash payments to suppliers in the cash flow.

(c) Change in investment in associates


221
The change may occur as a result of:

(i) Additional shares being purchased or part of the shares held being sold;

(ii) Loans made to or received from associates or loans that have been previously taken
that are being repaid.

The cash consideration involved in any of these activities will be shown under investing
section of the cash flow statement.

Illustration 18.2

The following information has been extracted from the consolidated financial statements of
pious plc for the year ended 31 December 2007.

Consolidated profit and loss account


Nm Nm
Group profit before tax 1,000
Share of associated profit 167
Tax on profit: - -
Group tax 366 -
Share of tax of associate 82 448
1,615

Consolidated balance sheet


Nm Nm
Investment in associates:
Share of net assets 635 621
Loan to associates 518 409

Current assets:
Debtors 345 258

Included within the group:


Debtors are the following amounts-
Dividend receivable from associate 65 39
Current account with associate 54 95

Show the relevant figures to be included in the group cash flow statement for the year ended
31 December 2007 and the amount at which debtors will be shown in the reconciled net cash
inflow.

Suggested Solution 18.2

Extracts from cash flow statement


Nm

Cash flow from operating activities


Profit before tax N(1,000+167) 1,167
Share of associate’s profit (167)
Increase in debtors (w1) 61
222
Dividend received from associate (w2) 45

Investing activities
Loan to associate N(518-409) (109)

Workings
W1: increase in debtors 2007 2006
Nm Nm
Debtors per balance sheet 345 258
Less dividends receivable (65) (39)
280 219
Increase N m (280-219) = 61

W2: dividend received from associate

Associate
Nm Nm
Balance b/d share of tax 82
Share of net assets 621 dividend received (bal fig)
Dividend receivable 39 balance c/d 45
Share of profit 167 share of net assets 635
Dividend receivable 65
827 827

3.4 Joint Venture

If the joint venture is accounted for by the proportional consolidation, the consolidated cash
flow statement will include the investing company proportionate share of all the cash flows of
the jointly controlled enterprise.

If the equity method is used, the accounting for joint venture in the cash flow statement is
exactly the same with an associate.

3.5 Acquisition of Subsidiaries during the Accounting Period

(a) The cash flow of the subsidiaries acquired during the year will be included in the cash
flow statement from the date of acquisition

(b) Payments to acquire the subsidiary should be reported separately in the cash flow
statement under investing activities. Balances of cash and cash equivalents acquired
should be shown separately

(c) A note to the cash flow statement should show a summary of the effects of
acquisitions including how much of the consideration is made up in cash and cash
equivalents, and the assets and liabilities acquired

Illustration 18.3

Given below is the information concerning Dudu group:

223
Consolidated profit and loss account for the year ended 31 December 2007
N’000 N’000
Profit from operations:
Group companies 23,240
Associated company 1,372
Profit before taxation 24,612
Taxation:
Group companies 11,060
Associate 588 (11,648)
Profit after tax 12,964
Minority interests (2,170)
Group profit 10,794
Proposed dividend (2,940)
Retained profit 7,854
Retained profit brought forward 10,080
Retained profit carried forward 17,934

Consolidated balance sheet as at the year ended


31/12/07 31/12/06
N’000 N’000 N’000 N’000
Tangible fixed assets 29,680 23,660
Goodwill 616 392
Investment in associate 8,680 7,980
38,976 32,032
Current assets:
Stocks 23,240 17,080
Debtors 21,000 13,020
Cash in hand 70 2,023
(a) 44,310 32,123
Less: current liabilities
Trade creditors 10,780 8,120
Taxation 12,740 6,860
Proposed dividend 2,940 1,960
Bank overdraft 1,792 _____
(b) 28,252 16,940
Net current assets (a-b) 16,058 15,183
55,034 47,215
Financed by:
Ordinary share capital 19,600 18,200
Share premium 3,703 2,303
Consolidated reserves 17,934 10,080
41,237 30,583
Minority interest 11,480 9,240
52,717 39,823
10% debentures 2,317 7,392
55,034 47,215

Notes:
(i) On July 2007, dudu group acquired 80% of the issued share capital of osun plc, whose net
assets at that date were as follows:
N’000
224
Tangible fixed assets 3,640
Stock 1,260
Debtors 1,372
Cash 280
Creditors (1,932)
Taxation (420)
4,200

The purchase consideration was N3.9million in cash

(ii) Depreciation charged in the year amounted to N3,080,000. There were no disposals of
fixed assets during the year

Required: prepare a cash flow statement of dudu group.

Suggested Solution 18.3

Step 1: movement on:


At 1/1/07 + new acquisition – at 31/12/07 = as per cash flow statement

N’000 N’000 N’000 N’000


Stock 17,080 + 1,260 - 23,240 = 4,900
Debtors 13,020 + 1,372 - 21,000 = 6,608
Creditors 8,120 + 1,932 - 10,780 = 728

Step 2: amortization of goodwill/ impairment loss written off


N’000
Opening balance 392
Increase due to acquisition N3.9- (80% x N4.2) 540
Amortization (bal fig) (316)
Closing balance 616

Step 3: dividend paid to minority shareholders


N’000
Minority interest at 1/1/07 9,240
Minority interest in profit for the year 2,170
Increase in minority interest due to acquisition 840
Dividend paid to minority shareholders (bal fig) (770)
Minority interest at 31 December 2007 11,480

Increase in minority interest due to acquisition in the identifiable net asset acquired times
20%/ i.e N4.2m x 20% = N840,000

Step 4: dividend received from associates N’000


Investments in associates at 1/1/07 7,980
Share of associate profit before tax 1,372
Share of tax charged for the year (588)
Dividend received in the year (bal fig) (84)
8,680

Step 5: tax paid during the year


225
N’000
Balance at 1/1/07 6,860
Increase due to acquisition of Osun 420
Charge for the year 11,060
Cash paid (bal fig) (5,600)
Balance at 31/12/07 12,740

Step 6: movement in fixed assets


N’000
Balance at 1/1/07 23,660
Additions in the year:
Due to acquisition of osun 3,640
Others (bal fig) 5,460
Depreciation charge for the year (3,080)
Balance at 31/12/07 29,680

Step 7: ordinary shares


Nominal value Premium
N’000 N’000
Bal b/d 18,200 2,303
Issue of share (bal fig) 1,400 1,400
Bal c/d 19,600 3,703

Step 8: prepare cash flow statement


Dudu plc
Consolidated cash flow statement for the
Year ended 31 December 2007

N’000 N’000
Cash flows from operating activities
Profit before tax 24,612
Adjustments for:
Amortization (for step 2) 316
Depreciation charges 3,080
Share of associate’s profit (1,372)
Operating profit before working capital changes 26,636

Increase in stock (step 1) (4,900)


Increase in debtors (step 1) (6,608)
Increase in creditors 728
Cash generated from operations 15,856
Dividend received from associates (step 4) 84
Income tax paid (5,600)
10,340
Net cash from investing activities
Acquisition of Osun net of cash acquired (note 1) (3,620)
Purchases of fixed assets (step 6) (5,460)
Net cash used in investing activities (9,080)

Cash flow from financing activities


Issue of ordinary shares (step 7) 2,800
226
Redemption of debentures (5,075)
Dividend paid to minority shareholders (770)
Dividends paid to dudu shareholders (1,960)
Net cash used in financing activities (5,005)
Net decrease in cash and cash equivalents (3,745)
Cash and cash equivalents at the beginning 2,023
Decrease in cash (1,722)

Notes to the cash flow statement


Cash and cash equivalents
2007 2006
N’000 N’000
Cash in hand 70 2,023
Bank overdraft (1,792) -____
Net cash and cash equivalents1,722 2,023

The cash outflow in respect of the purchase of Osun in the accounting period is the amount
paid (N3.9) less the cash balance of Osun at the date of acquisition, obtained as follows:

N’000
Cash paid on acquisition 3,900
Cash balance of Osun (280)
Cash outflow 3,620

Self Assessment Exercises

1. Payments to acquire a subsidiary is reported separately in the cash flow statement under
_______
(a) Investing
(b) Trading
(c) Financing
(d) Operating
(e) Out sourcing

2. Dividends paid to minority shareholders are _______ that are extended to the group and
will be shown under financing activities.
(a) Expenses
(b) Cash flows
(c) Incomes
(d) Services
(e) Adjustments

4.0 CONCLUSION

This unit discloses the treatment of group cash flow when dealing with subsidiaries with non
controlling interest, associates, and investments acquired during the accounting period.

5.0 SUMMARY

The unit goes on to further throw more light on cash flows statements in terms of group
accounts.
227
With the conclusion of this unit, we have come to the end of this course. We congratulate
you on the successful conclusion of this course.

6.0 TUTOR-MARKED ASSIGNMENT

Try your hands on all the illustrations in the three modules to keep abreast of the principles
and procedures guiding the preparation of the accounts.

7.0 REFERENCES/FURTHER READINGS

Adapted from the ICAN Study Packs (2011)

228

You might also like